Road Traffic Act 1974

Road Traffic Code 2000

 

Road Traffic Code 2000

Contents

Part 1 — Preliminary

1.Citation1

2.Commencement1

3.Terms and abbreviations used1

Part 2 — Application

4.Scope of regulations40

4A.Minister may declare Code requirements do not apply40

4B.Minister may designate shared zones40

5.Infringement notices not to be issued to children under 1440

7.Requirement to give way, effect of41

8A.Requirement to stop as near as practicable to place, effect of41

8.Offence against local laws not offence against this Code42

9.Penalties42

10.Repeal43

Part 3 — Speed restrictions

11.Speed limits generally44

11A.“When blank” signs47

12.Minimum speeds on freeways48

13.Heavy vehicles and vehicles towing trailers48

14.Heavy vehicle speed zones49

16.Speed restriction on bridge49

17.Penalties for speeding50

18.Reckless driving generally52

18A.Evasive action in relation to speed camera52

Part 4 — Making turns

Division 1 — Left turns at intersections

19.Application of Division54

20.Left turns (single lanes)54

21.Left turns (multiple lanes)55

22.Making left turn as indicated by turn line58

Division 2 — Right turns (other than hook turns) at intersections

23.Application of Division59

24.Right turns (two‑way, single lanes)59

25.Right turns (one‑way, single lanes)61

26.Right turns from multi‑lane carriageway62

27.Making a right turn (generally)64

Division 3 — Hook turns by bicycles at intersections

28.Optional hook turn by bicycle rider66

29.Bicycle rider making hook turn contrary to sign68

Division 4 — U turns

30.U turns on carriageway69

31.U turns at intersection70

32.U turns generally71

Division 5 — Turns from a carriageway to land abutting the carriageway

33.Turns to enter abutting land73

Part 5 — Turning and stop signals

34.Terms used74

35.When drivers are to give signals75

36.How drivers are to give signals75

37.How long should hand signals be given78

38.Use of signalling devices78

Part 6 — Traffic‑control signals (traffic lights and twin alternating red lights)

Division 1 — Obeying traffic‑control signals (traffic lights)

39.Proceeding when faced with circular green signal or green arrow80

39A.Effect of traffic‑control signal accompanied by “one vehicle per green each lane” sign80

40.Stopping for circular red signal or red arrow82

41A.Motor vehicles not to enter bicycle storage area84

41.Stopping for circular yellow signal or yellow arrow85

42.Green arrow with red or yellow signal, effect of86

43.Turning left on red signal86

43A.Effect of green bicycle light with red or yellow signals87

43B.Effect of red bicycle light with green arrow signal87

44.What to do if signals change when intersection congested etc.88

Division 2 — Giving way at traffic‑control signals (traffic lights)

45.Right of way during turns at intersection with traffic‑control signals89

46.Giving way at intersection with traffic‑control signals not operating or only partly operating91

47.Giving way at flashing yellow traffic arrow at intersection92

48.Giving way at crossing (other than at intersection) with flashing yellow traffic‑control signal92

Division 3 — Twin alternating red lights

49.Stopping for twin alternating red lights (except at level crossings)93

Part 7 — Giving way

Division 1 — Places with a stop sign, stop line, give way sign or give way line applying to the driver

50.Stopping and giving way at stop sign or stop line at intersection without traffic‑control signals94

51.Stopping and giving way at stop sign or stop line at other places96

52.Giving way at give way sign or give way line at intersection97

53.Giving way at give way sign at bridge or length of narrow carriageway99

54.Giving way at give way sign or give way line at other places99

Division 2 — Giving way at an intersection without traffic‑control signals or a stop sign, stop line, give way sign or give way line applying to the driver

55.Giving way at intersection (except T‑intersection or roundabout)100

56.Giving way at T‑intersection105

Division 3 — Entering or leaving land abutting a carriageway or road

57.Giving way when entering carriageway from land abutting carriageway or road109

58.Giving way when entering land abutting carriageway or road from carriageway110

Division 4 — Keeping clear of and giving way to particular vehicles

59.Giving way to public buses112

60.Keeping clear of police and emergency vehicles113

Division 5 — Crossings and shared zones

61.Children’s crossings113

62.Pedestrian crossings115

63.Overtaking or passing vehicle at children’s crossing or pedestrian crossing117

64.Giving way to pedestrians in shared zone117

Division 6 — Other give way requirements

65.Giving way when driving through break in median strip118

66.Giving way on painted island119

67.Giving way in median turning bay121

68.Giving way when moving from boundary of carriageway, or parking area on or in median strip122

Part 8 — Traffic signs and road markings

Division 1 — Traffic signs and road markings at intersections and other places

69.Left turn only signs123

70.Right turn only signs123

71.No turns signs124

72.No left turn and no right turn signs125

73.Traffic lane arrows127

Division 2 — Traffic signs and road markings generally

74.No overtaking or passing signs128

75.No overtaking on bridge sign129

76.Emergency stopping lane only signs130

76A.Emergency stopping bay signs130

77.Keep clear markings131

78.Road access signs132

79.Further restrictions on freeways133

80.One‑way signs134

81.Keep left and keep right signs135

82.No entry signs136

83.Hand‑held stop signs136

Division 3 — Signs for trucks, buses and other large vehicles

84.Clearance and low clearance signs137

85.Load limit signs138

86.No trucks signs139

87.Trucks must enter signs140

88.No buses signs140

89.Buses must enter signs141

90.Trucks and buses low gear signs142

91A.Safety ramp and arrester bed signs143

Part 9 — Roundabouts

91.Terms used144

92.Entering multi‑lane roundabout144

93.Indicating left when entering roundabout148

94.Indicating right when entering roundabout149

95.Right of way in roundabout149

96.Driving through roundabout149

97.Obeying marked arrows when driving in or leaving roundabout150

98.Indicating when changing lanes or lines of traffic in roundabout150

99.Indicating left when leaving roundabout151

100.Rider of bicycle or animal to give way to vehicle leaving roundabout151

Part 10 — Level crossings

101.Stopping at level crossing152

102.Approaching trains152

103.Giving way at level crossing153

104.What to do if traffic is congested153

105.Leaving level crossing154

106.Stopping at level crossing when vehicle is carrying dangerous goods154

107.Driving around boom gates154

Part 11 — Keeping left, overtaking and other driving provisions

Division 1 — General

108.Obstruction of vehicles and pedestrians155

109.Keeping safe distance behind vehicles155

110.Keeping minimum distance between long vehicles156

111.No entry to choked intersection157

Division 2 — Keeping to the left

112.Keeping as far left as practicable157

113.Restriction on use of right lane158

114.Keeping to left of oncoming vehicles160

115.Keeping to left of marked or unmarked two‑way carriageway161

116.Keeping to left of continuous dividing lines162

117.Keeping to left of median strip164

118.Service roads164

119.Driving on or across median strip, painted island etc.165

120.Avoiding obstructions on carriageway168

Division 3 — Overtaking

121.No overtaking unless safe to do so169

122.Overtaking169

123.Passing or overtaking vehicle displaying do not overtake turning vehicle sign170

124.Keeping safe distance when overtaking171

124A.Keeping safe distance when passing bicycle171

125.Courtesy when overtaking173

Division 4 — Driving in marked lanes or lines of traffic

126.Driving in single lane on carriageway174

127.Moving from one marked lane to another marked lane across continuous line separating lanes176

128.Giving way when lines of traffic merge into single line of traffic177

129.Driving on or across continuous white edge line178

130.Riding 2‑wheeled vehicle alongside more than one other rider179

130A.Rider of motor cycle not to ride next to other vehicles except in certain circumstances180

130B.When rider of a motor cycle is lawfully lane filtering181

Division 5 — Obeying overhead traffic‑control signals applying to marked lanes

131.Overhead traffic‑control signals183

Division 6 — Driving in marked lanes designated for special purposes

132.Bicycle lanes185

133.Bus lanes186

133A.Busways186

134.Transit lanes188

135.Truck lanes189

136.Exceptions to driving in special purpose lanes etc.189

137.Marked lanes required to be used by particular kinds of vehicles191

Division 6A — Stationary incident response vehicles

137A.Approaching and passing stationary incident response vehicles192

Division 7 — Freight containers

138A.Freight container not to be driven on prohibited road193

138B.Signs194

Part 12 — Restrictions on stopping and parking

Division 1 — General

138.Stopping in an emergency etc. or to comply with another regulation195

139.Application of this Part to bicycles196

Division 2 — No stopping and no parking signs, and yellow edge lines

140.No stopping signs196

141.No parking signs197

142.No stopping on carriageway with yellow edge line198

Division 3 — Stopping at intersections and crossings

143.Prohibited stopping places198

144.Stopping on or near children’s crossing or pedestrian crossing200

145.Stopping on or near marked foot crossing (except at intersection)201

146.Stopping at or near bicycle crossing lights (except at intersection)202

147.Stopping on or near level crossing203

Division 4 — Stopping on clearways and freeways and in emergency stopping bays and lanes and red X lanes

148.Stopping on clearway204

149.Stopping on freeway205

150.Stopping in emergency stopping bay, emergency stopping lane or red X lane206

Division 5 — Stopping in zones for particular vehicles

151.Stopping in loading zone208

152.Stopping in truck zone208

153.Stopping in works zone etc.209

154.Stopping in taxi zone or bus zone210

155.Stopping in mail zone211

156.Other limitations in zones211

Division 6 — Other places where stopping is restricted

157.Stopping in bus lane, transit lane, truck lane or bicycle lane212

158.Stopping in shared zone212

159.Double parking213

160.Stopping near obstruction214

161.Stopping on bridge or in tunnel etc.214

162.Restriction on stopping vehicle on crests, curves etc.215

163.Stopping near fire hydrant etc.216

164.Stopping at or near bus stop217

165.Stopping on path, dividing strip, nature strip or painted island217

166.Obstructing access to and from path, driveway etc.218

167.Stopping near letter box219

168.Stopping on carriageway — heavy and long vehicles219

169.Stopping on carriageway with bicycle parking sign220

170.Stopping on carriageway with motor cycle parking sign220

171.Stopping in parking area for people with disabilities221

Division 7 — Permissive parking signs and parking fees

172.Information on or with permissive parking signs224

173A.Parking outside times indicated226

173.Parking for longer than indicated227

174.Time extension for people with disabilities227

175.Parking where fees are payable228

Division 8 — Parallel parking

176.Parallel parking on carriageway (except in median strip parking area)228

177.Parallel parking in median strip parking area231

Division 9 — Angle parking

178.Angle parking231

Division 10 — Other parking related provisions

179.Parking in parking bays234

180.Entering and leaving median strip parking area235

181.Making motor vehicle secure236

Part 13 — Lights and warning devices

Division 1 — Lights on motor vehicles

182.Lights on moving motor vehicles238

183.Using fog lights238

184.Lights on towed vehicles239

185.Using headlights on high‑beam240

186.Lights not to be used to dazzle other road users241

187.Using lights on some stopped vehicles241

188.Using hazard warning lights242

Division 2 — Lights on animal‑drawn vehicles

189.Lights on animal‑drawn vehicles during hours of darkness or in hazardous weather conditions243

Division 3 — Horns

190.Use of horns etc.243

Division 4 — Portable warning signs for heavy vehicles

191.Portable warning signs for disabled heavy vehicles243

192.Fallen loadings from heavy vehicles requiring signs245

193.Restriction on flashing warning lights247

Part 14 — Pedestrians

Division 1 — General

194.No pedestrians signs248

195.Pedestrians on road with road access sign248

196.Crossing carriageway — general249

197.Crossing at pedestrian lights249

198.Crossing carriageway with traffic‑control signals that do not include pedestrian lights251

199.Crossing carriageway on or near crossing for pedestrians252

200.Crossing level crossing253

201.Pedestrians not to cause obstruction254

202.Getting on or into moving vehicle255

203.Pedestrians travelling along carriageway (except in or on wheeled recreational device or toy)255

204.Pedestrians on part of path designated for bicycles only256

Division 2 — Persons travelling in or on wheeled recreational devices, motorised scooters and wheeled toys

205.Games on roads259

206.Wheeled recreational device, motorised scooters and toys prohibited on certain carriageways and at certain times259

207.Travelling in or on wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy on carriageway260

208.Travelling in or on wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy on footpath or shared path261

209.Travelling on in‑line skates etc. on bicycle path or separated footpath261

209A.Protective helmets to be worn on motorised scooters262

210.Towing of wheeled recreational devices, motorised scooters and toys262

210A.Proper control of motorised scooters263

Part 15 — Additional provisions for bicycle riders and electric personal transporters (EPTs)

Division 1 — Bicycle riders

211.Riding bicycles264

212.Carrying people on bicycle264

213.Riding in bicycle lane265

214.Riding across a crossing265

215A.Entering bicycle storage area on bicycle265

215B.Giving way while entering or in bicycle storage area on bicycle266

215.Riding on wrong part of separated footpath267

216.Paths267

217.Riding to left of oncoming bicycle riders on path267

218.No bicycles signs and markings268

219.Bicycle riders not to cause obstruction269

220.Towing of bicycles269

221.Riding too close behind motor vehicle269

222.Protective helmets to be worn270

223A.Passengers to wear protective helmets271

223.Riding with person on bicycle trailer271

224.Lights and other equipment on bicycles272

225.Red bicycle crossing lights273

226.Stopping for yellow bicycle crossing light274

227.Proceeding when bicycle crossing lights change to yellow or red274

228.Riding power assisted pedal cycle with power assistance engaged276

229.Proper control of bicycles276

Division 2 — Electric personal transporters (EPTs)

Subdivision 1 — Preliminary

230A.Terms used277

230B.EPTs and EPT use areas277

Subdivision 2 — Provisions for EPT riders

230C.EPTs to be ridden in EPT use areas only278

230D.Riders to be at least 12 years of age278

230E.EPT to be supplied and supervised by commercial operator278

230F.Riders to wear protective helmets279

230G.Towing of EPTs prohibited279

230H.Riding EPTs279

230I.No passengers or animals on EPTs280

230J.EPT rider not to cause obstruction280

Subdivision 3 — Provisions for commercial operators of EPTs

230K.EPTs not to be able to exceed 10 km/h and to be fitted with warning devices280

230L.EPTs only to be for supervised tours or during training for supervised tours281

230M.Supervised tours281

230N.Records to be kept and supplied on demand282

Part 16 — Persons travelling on or in a vehicle

Division 1 — Preliminary

230.Terms used284

231.Medical certificate286

Division 2 — Requirement to wear seatbelts, etc.

232.Driver to wear seatbelt287

233.Wearing of seatbelts by passengers 16 years old or older287

234.Wearing of seatbelts by passengers under 16 years old289

235.Specific exemptions from wearing seatbelts and defences292

235A.Penalties for seatbelt offences by driver295

Division 4 — Exceptions

240.Exemptions298

241.Police to consider safety of alleged offenders299

Division 5 — Other duties

242.Body or limbs protruding from vehicles299

243.Opening doors and alighting from vehicles301

244.Drivers and pillion passengers upon motor cycles to wear protective helmets301

245.Motor cycle rider to be properly seated302

246A.Passengers on 2‑wheeled motor cycles303

246B.Passengers on trikes and motor cycles with sidecars304

246.Interfering with driver’s control of vehicle304

Part 17 — Additional provisions for drivers of public buses etc., in bus lanes

247A.Application of this Part306

247.Stopping for red B light306

248.Stopping for yellow B light306

249.Exception to stopping for red or yellow B light307

250.Proceeding after stopping for red or yellow B light307

251.Proceeding when traffic‑control signal shows circular red light and white B light or white traffic arrow is showing307

252.Proceeding when white B light or white arrow is no longer showing308

Part 18 — Miscellaneous provisions

Division 1 — Miscellaneous provisions for drivers

253.Driving on paths310

254.Driving on nature strip311

255.Creating excessive noise312

256.Putting glass etc. on roads313

257.Securing of loads314

258.Evidentiary provisions relating to securing of loads315

259.Selling papers and cars, hitch‑hiking etc.316

260.Vehicles etc. to have wheels317

261.Driving backwards317

263.Drivers to have uninterrupted and undistracted views etc.317

264A.Dogs etc. on motor cycles318

264.Use of visual display units etc. in vehicle319

265.Use of mobile phones320

Division 2 — Provisions for people in charge of animals

267.Leading animals324

268.Rider of animal on footpath or nature strip to give way to pedestrians324

269.Riding animal alongside more than one other rider324

270.Proper control of animals325

Division 3 — Directions by police and authorised persons

271.Authorised person to be declared325

272.Obedience to police or authorised persons325

273.Directions by police327

Division 4 — Unattended and unauthorised vehicles and stock on roads

275.Unattended stock on roads328

276.Restrictions on driving of stock328

277.Permit for driving of stock329

Division 5 — Towing

278.Towing a vehicle, trailer etc.329

279.Towed vehicles, trailers etc.332

Part 19 — Exemptions, specific local and transitional provisions

Division 1 — Exemptions

280.Exemption for drivers of emergency vehicles (police officers)333

281.Exemption for drivers of emergency vehicles (other)333

282A.Exemption for drivers of vehicles used in police driver training334

282.Stopping and parking exemption for emergency vehicles, police vehicles and authorised persons335

283.Exemption for police and emergency workers on foot or on patrol335

284.General exemptions from seatbelt provisions336

285.Exemption for road workers etc.337

285A.Exemption for operators of speed measuring equipment339

285B.Exemption for operators of “red light” cameras340

286.Exemption for oversize vehicles342

287.Exemption for tow truck drivers343

288A.Exemption for motor break‑down service vehicles344

288B.Exemption for Main Roads incident response service345

288.Exemption for postal vehicles345

289.Exemption for certain vehicles displaying flashing warning lights346

Division 2 — Specific local provisions

290.Processions and public meetings349

291.Temporary closure of or restriction on use of roads350

292.Restrictions on traffic in pedestrian mall350

292A.Directions when road under repair etc.351

Division 3 — Stop lines and give way lines

293.Stop signs and stop lines351

294.Give way signs and give way lines352

Part 20 — General

295.Authorisation to be in writing353

296.Delineation of parking areas etc.353

297.Power to erect traffic‑control signals and road signs353

298.Unauthorised use of various traffic‑related items356

299.Limits on operation of signs357

300.All traffic‑control signals and traffic signs to be operative357

301.Inscriptions on signs to have effect according to their tenor357

302.Variations in traffic signs etc.357

303A.Audible lines359

303.Operation of signs on holidays359

304.Symbols, lights and traffic related items etc.359

305.Representations of traffic signs, traffic‑control signals, symbols etc. in these regulations360

306.References to pedestrians crossing carriageway360

Schedule 1 — Abbreviations and symbols

Schedule 2 — Standard or commonly used traffic signs

Schedule 3 — Other permitted traffic signs

Schedule 4 — Symbols, lights and traffic‑related items

Schedule 5 — O’Connor Industrial Area

Notes

Compilation table402

Other notes407

Defined terms

 

Road Traffic Act 1974

Road Traffic Code 2000

Part 1 Preliminary

1.Citation

These regulations may be cited as the Road Traffic Code 2000.

2.Commencement

These regulations come into operation on 1 December 2000.

3.Terms and abbreviations used

(1)In these regulations —

alcohol ignition interlock device means a device in a vehicle that is designed to prevent the vehicle from being started or driven unless the device is supplied with a breath sample that contains either no alcohol, or less than a certain concentration of alcohol;

articulated vehicle means a motor vehicle having at its rear a portion on wheels that is pivoted to, and part of which is superimposed on and supported by, the front portion of the vehicle;

authorised body means a government department, government instrumentality, statutory authority, local government or a body authorised by the Commissioner of Main Roads for the purposes of regulation 297(2);

authorised person means a person authorised by the Commissioner of Police under regulation 271;

B light means a traffic‑control signal showing a red, white or yellow B light;

Example

White B light

B lights means a traffic‑control signal designed to show a B light, or 2 or more B lights at different times;

bicycle means a vehicle with 2 or more wheels that is built to be propelled by human power through a belt, chain or gears (whether or not it has an auxiliary motor) and —

(a)includes a pedicab, penny‑farthing, tricycle and power assisted pedal cycle; but

(b)does not include a wheelchair, wheeled recreational device, wheeled toy or any vehicle (other than a power assisted pedal cycle) with an auxiliary motor capable of generating a power output over 200 watts (whether or not the motor is operating);

bicycle crossing lights means a device designed to show, at different times, a green, yellow or red bicycle crossing light;

Example

Red bicycle crossing light

(bicycle symbol in red)

Green bicycle crossing light

(bicycle symbol in green)

Yellow bicycle crossing light

(bicycle symbol in yellow)

bicycle hook turn storage area means an area between an intersection and a marked foot crossing, or if there is no marked foot crossing, a stop line, before the intersection that has painted on it one or more bicycle symbols and one or more right traffic lane arrows, and includes any line that delineates the right side of the area, and any line that delineates the left side of the area that is not also a stop line or part of a marked foot crossing but does not include a bicycle storage area;

bicycle lane means a marked lane, or the part of a marked lane —

(a)beginning at a “bicycle lane” sign applying to the lane, or a road marking comprising a white bicycle symbol and the word “lane” painted in white; and

(b)ending at the nearest of the following —

(i)an “end bicycle lane” sign applying to the lane, or a road marking comprising a white bicycle symbol and the words “end lane” painted in white;

(ii)an intersection (unless the lane is at the unbroken side of the continuing road at a T‑intersection or continued across the intersection by broken lines);

(iii)if the carriageway ends at a dead end — the end of the carriageway;

Bicycle lane sign

End bicycle lane sign

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of the “bicycle lane” sign, and another permitted version of the “end bicycle lane” sign.

bicycle path means a length of path beginning at a “bicycle path” sign or a “bicycle path” road marking and ending at the nearest of the following:

(a)an “end bicycle path” sign, or an “end bicycle path” road marking;

(b)a “separated footpath” sign or a “separated footpath” road marking;

(c)a carriageway;

(d)the end of the path;

Bicycle path sign

End bicycle path sign

Separated footpath sign

bicycle path road marking means a road marking consisting of a bicycle symbol, the words “bicycles only”, or both the bicycle symbol and the word “only”;

bicycle storage area means an area of road before an intersection with traffic control signals —

(a)that has painted on it one or more bicycle symbols; and

(b)that is between 2 parallel stop lines, regardless of whether the lines are of equal length; and

(c)that opens out from a bicycle lane or shoulder,

but does not include either stop line;

Botanic Gardens and Parks Authority means the body established under section 4 of the Botanic Gardens and Parks Authority Act 1998;

built‑up area means the territory contiguous to and including any road —

(a)on which there is provision for street lighting at intervals of not over 100 m for a distance of at least 500 m or, if the road is shorter than 500 m, for the whole road; or

(b)which is built up with structures devoted to business, industry or dwelling houses at intervals of less than 100 m for a distance of 500 m or more;

bus means a motor vehicle, built mainly to carry people, that seats over 12 adults (including the driver);

bus embayment means an embayment at the side of a carriageway, designed so that a public bus can be driven into it, for the purpose of allowing passengers to alight or enter, without impeding the flow of traffic on that carriageway, but does not include a bus lane;

bus lane means a marked lane, or the part of a marked lane of a carriageway —

(a)beginning at a “bus lane” sign (whether or not there is also a “bus lane” road marking) and ending at the nearest of the following —

(i)an “end bus lane” sign;

(ii)a traffic sign that indicates the beginning of another special purpose lane;

or

(b)beginning at a “bus lane” road marking (if there is no “bus lane” sign) and ending at the next intersection;

Bus lane sign

End bus lane sign

bus lane” road marking means a road marking consisting of —

(a)the letters ‘BL’; or

(b)the words ‘bus lane’; or

(c)the words ‘bus only’;

bus stop means a length of carriageway commencing 20 m on the approach side of, and ending 10 m on the departure side of, a post indicating that public buses stop at that point;

busway means a portion of a carriageway that is —

(a)enclosed in a manner intended to prevent vehicles from moving into that portion of the carriageway other than at the beginning of the portion of carriageway; and

(b)defined by a “busway” sign at its beginning and an “end busway” sign at its end;

Busway sign

End busway sign

Busway cropped

Busway and end cropped

bus zone means a length of carriageway to which a “bus zone” sign applies;

Bus zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of this sign.

Note   A “bus zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and anything on the sign may be differently arranged.

carriageway means a portion of a road that is improved, designed or ordinarily used for vehicular traffic, and includes the shoulders, and areas, including embayments, at the side or centre of the carriageway, used for the stopping or parking of vehicles; and, where a road has 2 or more of those portions divided by a median strip, the expression means each of those portions, separately;

centre, in relation to a carriageway, means a line or a series of lines, marks, or other indications —

(a)for a two‑way carriageway — placed so as to delineate vehicular traffic travelling in different directions; or

(b)in the absence of any such lines, marks or other indications — the middle of the main, travelled portion of the carriageway;

 

children’s crossing means a portion of a carriageway between 2 parallel broken or unbroken lines, each approximately 150 mm wide and not more than 5 m apart marked across, or partly across the carriageway and near which “children crossing – stop” signs are displayed and, where the lines are so marked partly across a carriageway, includes the portion of the carriageway between the prolongations of those lines;

Children crossing — stop sign

(octagonal background in red)

(square background in lime/yellow)

combination has the meaning given in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 3;

continuing road in relation to a T‑intersection, means the carriageway that meets the terminating road at the T‑intersection;

default speed limit, for a vehicle —

(a)that is limited to a particular speed limit by these regulations that is slower than 110 km/h, means that slower speed limit; or

(b)that is not otherwise limited to a particular speed limit by these regulations, means a speed limit of 110 km/h;

de-restriction sign means a sign that indicates the end of a speed restriction, and replacing it with the default speed limit;

De-restriction sign

dipped, in relation to the main beam of light projected by the headlight of a motor vehicle, means in the low‑beam position within the meaning of the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 3;

dipping device means a device by which the driver of a motor vehicle, while retaining his or her normal driving position, can cause the main beam or beams of light from the headlight or headlights of the vehicle to be dipped;

disability parking permit has the meaning given in the Local Government (Parking for People with Disabilities) Regulations 2014 section 4;

dividing line means a road marking formed by a line, or 2 parallel lines, whether broken or continuous, or by a series of reflective markers, intended to divide a road lengthways into separate carriageways, to be used by vehicles travelling in opposite directions;

dividing strip means an area or structure that divides a road lengthways into separate carriageways, but does not include a nature strip, bicycle path, footpath or shared path;

edge line, for a carriageway, means a line marked along the carriageway at or near the far left or far right side of the carriageway;

electric personal transporter means a vehicle declared as an electric personal transporter under regulation 230B;

electric personal transporter use area means an area declared as an electric personal transporter use area under regulation 230B;

emergency stopping bay means a bay to which an “emergency stopping bay” sign applies;

Emergency stopping bay signs

(background to “emergency” in red)

(background to phone in blue)

Emergency Stopping Bay Only

Note   The sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction.

emergency stopping lane means a marked lane, or the part of a marked lane, to which an “emergency stopping lane only” sign applies;

Emergency stopping lane only sign

Note   The sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction.

emergency vehicle means a vehicle —

(a)when conveying a police officer on official duty or when that vehicle is stationary at any place connected with the official duty; or

(b)of a fire brigade on official duty in consequence of a fire or an alarm of fire or of an emergency or rescue operation where human life is reasonably considered to be in danger; or

(c)being an ambulance, answering an urgent call or conveying any injured or sick person to any place for the provision of urgent treatment; or

(d)being used to obtain or convey blood or other supplies, drugs or equipment for a person urgently requiring treatment and duly authorised to carry a siren or bell for use as a warning instrument; or

(e)duly authorised as an emergency vehicle for the purposes of these regulations, by the CEO;

“end of heavy vehicle speed zone” sign means a sign, erected near the boundary of a carriageway to face approaching drivers, that is substantially rectangular in shape and consists of the message “END OF HEAVY VEHICLE SPEED ZONE” in black lettering upon a white background;

fire hydrant means an upright pipe with a spout, nozzle or other outlet for drawing water from a main or service pipe in case of fire or other emergency;

Examples

Fire hydrant indicators

Fire plug indicator

footpath means an area that is open to the public that is designated for, or has as one of its main uses, use by pedestrians;

freeway means a road or portion of a road that is designated as a freeway by signs erected thereon or adjacent thereto;

Freeway signs

(background in green)(background in green)

End freeway sign

(background in green)

front fog light has the same meaning as in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 3;

give way line means a broken line marked across, or partly across, a carriageway that is not a part of a crossing;

Example

Give way line

heavy vehicle means a vehicle, other than a bus, that has, or together with any attached trailer and its load has, a GCM that is 22.5 t or more;

heavy vehicle speed zone means a length of carriageway, defined at its beginning by means of a “heavy vehicle speed zone” sign and at its end by means of an “end of heavy vehicle speed zone” sign;

“heavy vehicle speed zone” sign means a sign, erected near the boundary of a carriageway to face approaching drivers, that is substantially rectangular in shape and consists of —

(a)numerals in black set within a red circle; and

(b)the message “ALL VEHICLES 22.5 tonnes or more” in black lettering,

upon a white background;

holiday period has the meaning given in the Road Traffic (Authorisation to Drive) Regulations 2014 regulation 67;

hook turn means a turn made in accordance with Part 4 Division 3;

hours of darkness means the hours falling between sunset, on one day, and sunrise, on the succeeding day;

intersection means —

(a)the area where 2 or more carriageways meet; or

(b)the area within which vehicles, travelling by, on or from different carriageways may come into conflict;

keep clear marking means the words ‘keep clear’ marked across all or part of a carriageway, with or without continuous lines marked across all or part of the carriageway;

Examples

Example 1

Keep clear marking bounded by line road markings

Example 2

Keep clear marking with no line road markings


laned carriageway means a carriageway divided into 2 or more marked lanes for vehicular traffic;

level crossing means an area where a road and a railway meet at substantially the same level, together with the road area between the “level crossing” signs on the approaches to the railway and any adjacent area that is denoted by painted, crosshatched road markings;

Level crossing signs

(white cross on a red background)

licenced pilot vehicle driver means a person who holds a heavy vehicle pilot licence granted under the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 Part 13A;

loading zone means a length of a carriageway to which a “loading zone” sign applies;

Loading zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of this sign.

Note   A “loading zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and anything on the sign may be differently arranged.

mail zone means a length of carriageway to which a “mail zone” sign applies;

Mail zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   A “mail zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and anything on the sign may be differently arranged.

marked foot crossing means a portion of a carriageway —

(a)at a place with pedestrian lights facing pedestrians crossing the carriageway, and traffic‑control signals facing drivers driving on the carriageway; and

(b)indicated by a different road surface, or between 2 continuous or broken lines, or rows of studs or markers, on the road surface substantially from one side of the carriageway to the other;

median strip means any physical provision, other than lines, dividing a road to separate vehicular traffic proceeding in opposing directions or to separate 2 one‑way carriageways for vehicular traffic proceeding in opposing directions;

motor cycle means a motor vehicle that has 2 wheels and includes —

(a)a 2‑wheeled motor vehicle with a sidecar attached to it that is supported by a third wheel; and

(b)a motor vehicle with 3 wheels that is ridden in the same way as a motor vehicle with 2 wheels,

but does not include any trailer;

motorised scooter means a scooter that is propelled by one or more electric motors (whether the motors are a part of the scooter or attached to the scooter) and complies with the requirements of paragraph (e) in the definition of scooter;

motorised wheelchair means a motorised wheelchair that is designed so as to be not capable of a speed exceeding 10 km/h;

motor vehicle does not include a motorised scooter;

nature strip means an area between a carriageway and the front boundary of adjacent land, but does not include a path;

no bicycles road marking means a road marking consisting of a bicycle symbol with a diagonal line across it, or the words “no bicycles”, or both the symbol and the words;

no parking area means —

(a)a portion of carriageway to which a “no parking” sign applies; or

(b)an area to which a “no parking” sign applies;

No parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(circle, slash and arrow in red)

No parking sign
(for an area)

(circle and slash in red)

Note   A “no parking” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction.

no stopping area means —

(a)a portion of carriageway to which a “no stopping” sign applies; or

(b)an area to which a “no stopping” sign applies;

No stopping sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(circle, slash and arrow in red)

No stopping sign
(for an area)

(circle and slash in red)

Note   A “no stopping” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction.

obstruction includes a traffic hazard, but does not include a vehicle only because the vehicle is stopped in traffic or is travelling more slowly than other vehicles;

on‑demand rank or hail vehicle authorisation means a passenger transport vehicle authorisation (as defined in the Transport (Road Passenger Services) Act 2018 section 4(1)) that authorises the operation of the vehicle for use in providing an on‑demand rank or hail passenger transport service (as defined in that section);

one‑way carriageway means a carriageway on which vehicles are permitted to travel in one direction only;

overhead controlled lane means a marked lane that is part of a laned carriageway where separate traffic‑control signals or variable illuminated signs capable of being speed limit signs are erected over each lane of that laned carriageway;

oversize has the same meaning as in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 3;

painted island means an area of road —

(a)entirely surrounded by a line or lines (whether broken or continuous); or

(b)surrounded partly by a line or lines (whether broken or continuous) and partly by a kerb on or next to the carriageway,

which may be further identified by stripes or chevrons marked on the enclosed road surface, or by the enclosed road surface being a contrasting colour, but not including the road within a dividing line;

park means to permit a vehicle, whether attended or not, to remain stationary, except for the purpose of —

(a)avoiding conflict with other traffic; or

(b)complying with the provisions of any law; or

(c)taking up or setting down persons or goods (maximum of 2 minutes);

parking area means —

(a)a portion of carriageway to which a “permissive parking” sign applies; or

(b)an area to which a “permissive parking” sign applies;

Permissive parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

Permissive parking sign
(for an area)

Permissive parking sign displaying a people with disabilities symbol
(for a length of road)

Permissive parking sign displaying a people with disabilities symbol
(for an area)

parking control sign means any of the following:

(a)a “bicycle parking” sign;

(b)a “bus zone” sign or bus stop post;

(c)a “clearway” sign;

(d)a “loading zone” sign;

(e)a “mail zone” sign;

(f)a “motor cycle parking” sign;

(g)a “no parking” sign;

(h)a “no stopping” sign;

(i)a “people with disabilities parking” sign;

(j)a “permissive parking” sign;

(k)a “permissive parking” sign displaying a “people with disabilities” symbol;

(l)a “taxi zone” sign;

(m)a “truck zone” sign;

(p)a “works zone” sign;

passenger transport vehicle has the meaning given in the Transport (Road Passenger Services) Act 2018 section 4(1);

path includes bicycle path, footpath, separated footpath and shared path;

pedestrian means any person on foot or in a perambulator, or a physically disabled person in an unmotorised wheelchair or in a motorised wheelchair, and includes —

(a)a person pushing a perambulator or wheelchair; and

(b)a person wheeling a bicycle or a wheeled toy, if the person is completely dismounted from the bicycle or wheeled toy; and

(c)a person in or on a wheeled recreational device or a motorised scooter; and

(d)a person under 12 years of age in or on a wheeled toy;

pedestrian crossing means a portion of a carriageway —

(a)defined —

(i)by white stripes; or

(ii)by white or yellow stripes (according to the colour of the carriageway) and the portions of the carriageway lying between those stripes,

in such a manner that each stripe is approximately parallel to the centre of the carriageway; and

(b)near each end of which may be erected, on each side of the carriageway, so as to be clearly visible to an approaching driver, a “pedestrian crossing” sign;

Pedestrian crossing sign

(background in yellow)

pedestrian light means a device designed to show, at different times —

(a)a red pedestrian light – being either an illuminated red pedestrian symbol (whether or not flashing), or the words ‘don’t walk’ illuminated in red (whether or not flashing); or

(b)green pedestrian light – being an illuminated green pedestrian symbol, or the word ‘walk’ illuminated in green (whether or not flashing);

Red pedestrian light showing red pedestrian symbol

Green pedestrian light showing green pedestrian symbol

pedestrian mall means any road or portion of a road that is designated as a pedestrian mall by signs erected thereon or adjacent thereto;

postal vehicle means a motor vehicle or bicycle driven or ridden by a person in the course of collecting or delivering postal articles for, or on behalf of, the Australian Postal Corporation;

public bus means a bus operated by or on behalf of the State as a passenger vehicle, to carry passengers for hire or reward, whether in connection with a railway or not, but does not include a vehicle in relation to which an on‑demand rank or hail vehicle authorisation is in force;

rear fog light has the same meaning as in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 226;

red X lane means a length of overhead controlled lane beginning at a traffic‑control signal over that lane displaying an illuminated red diagonal cross and ending at the nearest of the following —

(a)another traffic‑control signal over that lane displaying an illuminated red diagonal cross;

(b)another traffic‑control signal over that lane displaying an illuminated white, green or yellow arrow pointing downwards;

(c)a speed limit sign over that lane;

(d)a speed limit sign erected on or near the carriageway of which the overhead controlled lane is part;

Illuminated red diagonal cross

(cross in red)

rider means the driver of, or person riding, a motor cycle, bicycle, electric personal transporter, animal or animal‑drawn vehicle, but does not include a passenger, or a person walking beside and wheeling a bicycle;

road marking means a word, figure, symbol, mark, line, raised marker or stud, on the surface of a carriageway, to direct or warn traffic;

road sign means a board, plate, screen, road marking, or other device, whether or not illuminated, displaying words, figures, symbols or anything else to direct or warn traffic on, entering or leaving a road;

school zone means a carriageway or length of carriageway —

(a)defined at its beginning by means of a “school zone” sign and at its end by means of an “end school zone” sign; or

(b)that forms part of a network of 2 or more carriageways defined by means of —

(i)“school zone” signs erected near the boundary of each carriageway that provides access to the network, so that a driver can only lawfully enter the network on a carriageway by passing a “school zone” sign; and

(ii)“end school zone” signs erected near the boundary of each carriageway that provides an exit from the area, so that a driver can only lawfully exit the network on a carriageway by passing an “end school zone” sign;

School zone sign

End school zone sign

60

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of each of these signs.

school zone periods means the days (if any), and the periods (if any) during those days, that the speed limit indicated on a “school zone” sign has effect;

scooter means a device that —

(a)has 2 or more wheels and a footboard supported by those wheels; and

(b)is steered by handlebars; and

(c)is designed to be used by a single person; and

(d)is propelled by any one or more of the following —

(i)gravity;

(ii)the user pushing a foot against the ground;

(iii)an electric motor or motors;

and

(e)if it is fitted with an electric motor or motors, satisfies the following criteria —

(i)its maker certifies (either by means of a plate attached to the motor or on each motor, or by means of engraving on the motor or each motor) the ungoverned power output of the motor, or each motor;

(ii)the maximum power output of the motor, or the combined maximum power output of the motors, is not more than 200 watts;

(iii)when propelled only by the motor, or motors, the scooter is not capable of going faster than 10 km/h on level ground;

separated footpath means a length of footpath beginning at a “separated footpath” sign or a “separated footpath” road marking, and ending at the nearest of the following:

(a)an “end separated footpath” sign or an “end separated footpath” road marking;

(b)a “no bicycles” sign, or a “no bicycles” road marking;

(c)a “bicycle path” sign or “bicycle path” road marking;

(d)a carriageway;

(e)the end of the path;

Separated footpath sign

End separated footpath sign

No bicycles sign

(circle and slash in red)

Bicycle path sign

separated footpath road marking means a road marking consisting of a pedestrian symbol and a bicycle symbol side by side, with or without the word “only”;

service road means a carriageway that —

(a)is separated from other parts of a road by a dividing strip that is not designed or developed, wholly or mainly, to separate vehicles travelling in opposite directions; and

(b)is —

(i)designed or developed to be used, wholly or mainly, by vehicular traffic servicing adjacent land; or

(ii)indicated to be a service road by information on or with a traffic‑control signal on or adjacent to the carriageway;

shared path means an area open to the public (except a separated footpath) that is designated for, or has as one of its main uses, use by both the riders of bicycles and pedestrians, and includes a length of path beginning at a “shared path” sign or “shared path” road marking and ending at the nearest of the following:

(a)an “end shared path” sign or “end shared path” road marking;

(b)a “no bicycles” sign, or a “no bicycles” road marking;

(c)a “bicycle path” sign;

(d)a carriageway;

(e)the end of the path;

Shared path sign

End shared path sign

No bicycles sign

(circle and slash in red)

Bicycle path sign

shared path road marking means a road marking consisting of the symbols used in the “shared path” sign, and an “end shared path road marking” consists of those symbols with the word “END”;

shared zone means —

(aa)an area designated by the Minister as a shared zone under regulation 4B; or

(a)a length of road with —

(i)both a “shared zone” sign and an “end shared zone” sign; and

(ii)no intersection between the signs;

or

(b)a length of road with —

(i)a “shared zone” sign; and

(ii)a dead end; and

(iii)no intersection between the sign and the dead end;

or

(c)the network of roads in an area with —

(i)a “shared zone” sign on each road into the area, indicating the same number; and

(ii)an “end shared zone” sign on each road out of the area;

Shared zone sign

(circle in red)

End shared zone sign

Note   A “shared zone” sign may have a 10 or a 20 on the sign.

shared zone sign means a sign that is substantially rectangular in shape and consists of the following upon a white background —

(a)the numerals “10” or “20” in black set within a red circle;

(b)the words “SHARED ZONE” in black lettering;

(c)the symbol of a person next to the symbol of a car, each in black;

Shared zone sign

(circle in red)

Note   A “shared zone” sign may have a 10 or a 20 on the sign.

slip lane means an area of carriageway for vehicles turning left that is separated, at some point, from other parts of the road by some form of painted island or traffic island;

special purpose lane means a bicycle lane, bus lane, emergency stopping lane, red X lane, transit lane or truck lane;

special purpose vehicle means —

(a)a vehicle being driven by a police officer on official duty or that vehicle when it is stationary at any place connected with the official duty; or

(b)a public utility service truck; or

(c)a tow truck; or

(d)a motor break‑down service vehicle; or

(e)a vehicle being used by a State government agency or local government in connection with its roadwork or speed zoning functions; or

(f)a vehicle duly authorised as a special purpose vehicle for the purposes of these regulations, by the CEO,

but does not include an emergency vehicle;

speed limit, applicable to —

(a)a heavy vehicle speed zone, means the speed indicated by the numerals on the “heavy vehicle speed zone” sign at the beginning of the zone;

(b)a school zone, means the speed indicated by the numerals on the “school zone” sign at the beginning of the zone;

(c)a speed limited area, means the speed indicated by the numerals on the “area speed limit” sign on a road leading into the area;

(ca)a shared zone, means —

(i)in the case of a shared zone referred to in paragraph (aa) of the definition of shared zone — the speed specified by the Minister as being the speed limit applicable to the shared zone under regulation 4B; or

(ii)in the case of a shared zone referred to in paragraph (a) or (b) of the definition of shared zone — the speed indicated by the numerals on the “shared zone” sign at the beginning of the zone; or

(iii)in the case of a shared zone referred to in paragraph (c) of the definition of shared zone — the speed indicated by the numerals on the “shared zone” sign on a road leading into the zone;

(d)a speed zone, means the speed indicated by the numerals on the speed limit sign, at the beginning of the zone;

speed limited area means a carriageway or length of carriageway —

(a)defined at its beginning by means of an “area speed limit” sign and at its end by means of an “end area speed limit” sign; or

(b)that forms part of a network of 2 or more carriageways defined by means of —

(i)“area speed limit” signs erected near the boundary of each carriageway that provides access to the network, so that a driver can only lawfully enter the network on a carriageway by passing an “area speed limit” sign; and

(ii)“end area speed limit” signs erected near the boundary of each carriageway that provides an exit from the area, so that a driver can only lawfully exit the network on a carriageway by passing an “end area speed limit” sign;

Area speed limit sign

(circle in red)

End area speed limit sign

Area speed limit sign

(circle in red)

End area speed limit sign

 

Note for examples of signs   There are a number of other permitted versions of each of these signs.

speed limit sign means a sign (including a variable illuminated sign), other than an “area speed limit” sign, “school zone” sign, “shared zone” sign or “heavy vehicle speed zone” sign, that is substantially rectangular in shape and —

(a)is displayed or erected on or near a carriageway; and

(b)consists of one of the following —

(i)black numerals set within a white circle with a red outline upon a white background;

(ii)white numerals set within a black circle with a red outline upon a black background;

(iii)black numerals set within a white circle with a red outline upon a black background;

Speed limit sign
(Standard sign)

(circle in red)

Speed limit sign
(Variable illuminated sign)

(circle illuminated in red)

Speed limit sign
(Variable illuminated sign)

(circle illuminated in red)

 

Variable Speed Limit White Background

 

Note   A speed limit sign may have a different number on the sign.

speed zone means a length of carriageway defined at its beginning by means of a speed limit sign, and at its end by means of —

(a)a de‑restriction sign or an “end speed limit” sign; or

(b)another speed limit sign; or

(c)an “area speed limit” sign, a “school zone” sign or a “heavy vehicle speed zone” sign; or

(ca)the beginning of a shared zone; or

(d)a T‑intersection where that carriageway ends;

Speed limit signs

Speed limit sign
(Standard sign)

(circle in red)

Speed limit sign
(Variable illuminated sign)

(circle illuminated in red)

Speed limit sign
(Variable illuminated sign)

(circle illuminated in red)

 

Variable Speed Limit White Background

 

Other signs

End speed limit sign

De‑restriction sign

stop, in relation to a vehicle, means to stop the vehicle and permit it to remain stationary, except for the purpose of avoiding conflict with other traffic or of complying with the provisions of any law;

stop line means a continuous line —

(a)that is marked across all or part of a carriageway; and

(b)that is not part of a marked foot crossing, a keep clear marking or a bicycle hook turn storage area;

stop sign means an octagonal (or, if hand‑held, octagonal or round) sign, inscribed with the word “Stop”, requiring a driver to stop;

Traffic light‑stop sign

(background in red)

Stop sign

(background in red)

Hand‑held stop signs

(background in red)

(background in orange)

taxi means a vehicle used or intended to be used in providing an on‑demand rank or hail passenger transport service (as defined in the Transport (Road Passenger Services) Act 2018 section 4(1));

taxi zone means a length of carriageway to which a “taxi zone” sign applies;

Taxi zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of this sign.

Note   A “taxi zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and anything on the sign may be differently arranged.

terminating road in relation to a T‑intersection, means —

(a)if a carriageway at the intersection is designated by traffic signs or road markings, or in another way, as a carriageway that ends at the intersection — that carriageway; or

(b)in any other case — a carriageway that ends at the intersection;

T‑intersection means an intersection where 2 carriageways meet (whether or not at right angles) and one of the carriageways ends;

tow truck has the same meaning as in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 3;

traffic‑control signal means any light or lights (coloured or otherwise), however operated, for the control or regulation of traffic, by the use of an illuminated word or words, an illuminated symbol or symbols, a coloured light or coloured lights or any combination of those things;

traffic island means any physical provision, other than lines, marks or other indications on a carriageway, made at or near an intersection, to guide vehicular traffic;

traffic sign means one of the road signs, marks, structures or devices set out in Schedule 2 or 3 placed, or erected, on or near a road;

trailer means any vehicle without motive power of its own, designed for attachment to a motor vehicle for the purpose of being towed, but does not include the rear portion of an articulated vehicle, or a side‑car;

train means a railway locomotive or rolling stock;

transit lane means a marked lane, or the part of a marked lane —

(a)beginning at a “transit lane” sign; and

(b)ending at an “end transit lane” sign;

Transit lane signs

Transit lane (T2) sign

(background to T2 in red)

Transit lane (T3) sign

(background to T3 in red)

End transit lane signs

End transit lane (T2) sign

(background to T2 in red)

End transit lane (T3) sign

(background to T3 in red)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of the “transit lane” sign and another permitted version of the “end transit lane” sign.

truck means a motor vehicle with a GVM over 4.5 t, except a bus or tractor;

truck lane is a marked lane, or the part of a marked lane —

(a)beginning at a “truck lane” sign; and

(b)ending at an “end truck lane” sign;

Truck lane sign

End truck lane sign

Note   There is another permitted version of the “end truck lane” sign.

truck zone means a length of carriageway to which a “truck zone” sign applies;

Truck zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   There is another permitted version of this sign.

Note   A “truck zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and anything on the sign may be differently arranged.

turning lane means a portion of a marked lane on a carriageway set aside for turning vehicles by means of road markings or traffic signs;

turn line means a road marking at an intersection, consisting of either a broken or continuous line that is designed to indicate how a turn is to be made at that intersection;

two‑way carriageway means any carriageway for use by vehicular traffic travelling in opposite directions;

U turn means a turn by which a vehicle, facing or travelling on a carriageway in one direction, is made to face or travel in the opposite, or substantially in the opposite, direction, whether on the same or on another carriageway, but does not include a turn made at a roundabout;

variable illuminated speed limit sign means a speed limit sign that is a variable illuminated sign;

vehicle, in Parts 4 to 11 inclusive and in Part 18, does not include a wheeled toy or wheeled recreational device;

Vehicle Standards means the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 Parts 10, 11 and 13;

weekend means a Saturday and the following Sunday;

wheeled recreational device means a wheeled device, built to transport a person, propelled by human power or gravity, and ordinarily used for recreation or play —

(a)including —

(i)in‑line skates, rollerskates, a skateboard or similar wheeled device; and

(ii)a scooter being used by a person aged 12 years of age or older; and

(iii)a unicycle,

but

(b)not including a golf buggy, pram, stroller or trolley, or a bicycle, wheelchair or wheeled toy;

wheeled toy means a child’s pedal car, a tricycle, a scooter (other than a motorised scooter) or a similar toy, but only if it is being used by a child under 12 years of age;

works zone means a length of a road to which a “works zone” sign applies.

Works zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   There is another permitted version of this sign.

Note   A “works zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and anything on the sign may be differently arranged.

(2)For the purposes of these regulations, a reference to speed is a reference to speed measured in kilometres per hour.

[(3)deleted]

(4)In these regulations the following abbreviations are used —

EPT for electric personal transporter;

EPT use area for electric personal transporter use area.

[Regulation 3 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6752; 11 Jan 2002 p. 50; 8 Mar 2002 p. 946‑7; 1 Nov 2002 p. 5397‑8; 16 Apr 2003 p. 1240; 23 Sep 2003 p. 4167; 12 Dec 2003 p. 5048; 6 Apr 2004 p. 1135; 10 Dec 2004 p. 5917; 29 Dec 2006 p. 5921‑2 and 5924; 8 Feb 2008 p. 316 and 321‑2; 10 Jun 2008 p. 2466; 9 Oct 2009 p. 3996; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4541 and 4561‑4; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5749‑50; 18 Mar 2011 p. 926; 30 Aug 2011 p. 3517; 12 Apr 2013 p. 1533‑4; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6563; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4917‑19, 4928 and 4929; 13 Feb 2015 p. 651; 16 Oct 2015 p. 4152; 22 Dec 2015 p. 5131; 15 Nov 2016 p. 5062; 17 Oct 2017 p. 5338‑9; 15 May 2018 p. 1531; 28 Jun 2019 p. 2489; SL 2020/184 r. 4; SL 2020/253 r. 4.]

Part 2 Application

4.Scope of regulations

(1)Unless the context requires otherwise, these regulations apply to persons, vehicles and things on roads only, and where a provision of these regulations requires, or prohibits, the doing of any act or thing, that requirement or prohibition relates to the doing of that act or thing, on a road.

(2)Where a provision of these regulations requires, or prohibits, the doing of any act or thing on a path, that requirement or prohibition only relates to the doing of that act or thing, on the path if the path forms a part of a road.

4A.Minister may declare Code requirements do not apply

(1)The Minister may declare, in writing, that a specified requirement of this Code does not apply to a specified person or vehicle for a specified period of time.

(2)A declaration under subregulation (1) may set out a place to which the declaration is limited.

[Regulation 4A inserted: Gazette 11 Jun 2003 p. 2103.]

4B.Minister may designate shared zones

(1)The Minister may, by notice published in the Gazette —

(a)designate an area as a shared zone; and

(b)specify a speed limit applicable to that area of 20 km/h or less.

(2)The Minister may, by notice published in the Gazette, amend or repeal a notice made under subregulation (1).

[Regulation 4B inserted: SL 2020/253 r. 5.]

5.Infringement notices not to be issued to children under 14

Despite any regulation providing that an offender may be dealt with by way of an infringement notice and a modified penalty, an alleged offender against these regulations, under 14 years of age, is not to be dealt with by way of an infringement notice and modified penalty.

[6.Deleted: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4919.]

7.Requirement to give way, effect of

(1)Where any of these regulations require a driver or pedestrian to give way to a person or vehicle, the requirement takes effect when there is a reasonable possibility that, if he or she proceeded, he or she would collide or come into conflict with, or create any other dangerous situation with regard to, that person or vehicle; and, in that event, he or she is obliged to slow down to such an extent, or, as the circumstances may require, stop and remain stationary for such time, as may be necessary to allow the person or vehicle to continue on his, her or its course.

(2)Where any of these regulations require a driver who is turning from a carriageway at an intersection to give way to a pedestrian who is crossing the carriageway that the driver is entering, the requirement applies if and only if the pedestrian’s line of travel in crossing the carriageway is essentially perpendicular to the edges of the carriageway the driver is entering.

[Regulation 7 amended: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5750.]

8A.Requirement to stop as near as practicable to place, effect of

A requirement in these regulations for a driver to stop as near as practicable to a place is not complied with if the driver stops behind a vehicle that has stopped at the place.

Example

If a driver stops behind a vehicle that has stopped at a stop sign or stop line in accordance with regulation 50, 51 or 101, the driver must, after the vehicle has proceeded, stop at the stop sign or stop line in accordance with the regulation.

[Regulation 8A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4564.]

8.Offence against local laws not offence against this Code

(1)Where, in any particular case, the parking or stopping of a vehicle constitutes an offence against local laws in force in a local government district under the provisions of Part 3 Division 2 Subdivision 1 of the Local Government Act 1995, the parking or stopping of that vehicle does not constitute an offence against the provisions of this Code (other than regulation 108).

(2)Where a parking or stopping offence against a local law to which subregulation (1) applies is subject to conditions or exceptions, then a person who complies with all the conditions or is subject to the exceptions does not commit an offence under either the local law or this Code.

9.Penalties

(1)A person who contravenes or fails to comply with any of the provisions of these regulations, commits an offence.

(1A)A person who commits an offence against Part 16 Division 2 or regulation 244 is liable —

(a)for a first offence, to a minimum penalty of the number of penalty units that could be imposed as a modified penalty for the particular offence and a maximum penalty of 56 penalty units (56 PU); and

(b)for a subsequent offence, to a minimum penalty of the number of penalty units that could be imposed as a modified penalty for the particular offence and a maximum penalty of 84 penalty units (84 PU).

(1B)For the purposes of subregulation (1A)(b), an offence is regarded as a subsequent offence if the person by whom it is committed has previously committed an offence of any kind against Part 16 Division 2 or regulation 244.

(2)Except as provided in subregulation (1A), a person who commits an offence against these regulations is liable —

(a)for a first offence, to a penalty not exceeding 64 penalty units (64 PU); and

(b)for a subsequent offence, to a penalty not exceeding 96 penalty units (96 PU).

[(2a)deleted]

(3)For the purposes of subregulation (2), an offence against these regulations is taken to be a subsequent offence if the person by whom it is committed has previously committed an offence of any kind against these regulations, or against the Road Traffic Code 1975.

(4)The Road Traffic (Administration) Regulations 2014 regulation 24(2) makes provision in relation to infringement notice offences under these regulations and the penalties for those offences.

(5)The Road Traffic (Authorisation to Drive) Regulations 2014 regulation 65(3) makes provision in relation to demerit point offences under these regulations and the demerit points for those offences.

[Regulation 9 amended: Gazette 6 Apr 2004 p. 1135; 22 Dec 2006 p. 5817; 5 Apr 2007 p. 1555‑6; 29 Feb 2008 p. 694; 10 Jun 2008 p. 2467; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4920; 25 Jul 2017 p. 4079; SL 2020/253 r. 6.]

10.Repeal

The Road Traffic Code 1975 is repealed.

Part 3 Speed restrictions

11.Speed limits generally

(1)A person must not drive a vehicle at a speed exceeding the default speed limit for that vehicle.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

(2)A person must not drive a vehicle in a built‑up area, at a speed exceeding 50 km/h, except within a speed zone in which a higher speed is permitted.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

(3)A person must not drive a vehicle in a speed zone at a speed exceeding the speed limit applicable to the zone.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

Speed limit signs

Speed limit sign
(Standard sign)

(circle in red)

Speed limit sign
(Variable illuminated sign)

(circle illuminated in red)

Speed limit sign
(Variable illuminated sign)

(circle illuminated in red)

 

Variable Speed Limit White Background

 

(3A)For the purposes of subregulation (3), if the vehicle is in a speed zone that begins with a variable illuminated speed limit sign, the reference to the speed limit applicable to the zone is taken to be a reference to the speed limit applicable to the zone when the vehicle enters the zone.

(4)A person must not drive a vehicle in a shared zone at a speed exceeding the speed limit applicable to the zone.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

Shared zone sign

(circle in red)

End shared zone sign

(5)A person must not drive a vehicle in a speed limited area, at a speed exceeding the speed limit applicable to the area.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

Area speed limit sign

(circle in red)

End area speed limit sign

 

Area speed limit sign

(circle in red)

End area speed limit sign

 

Note for examples of signs   There are a number of other permitted versions of each of these signs.

(6)A person must not drive a vehicle in a school zone —

(a)at a speed exceeding the speed limit applicable to the zone; and

(b)during the school zone periods indicated on the “school zone” sign at the beginning of the zone.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

School zone sign

End school zone sign

60

(7)A person must not drive a vehicle in a pedestrian mall at a speed exceeding 10 km/h.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

[Regulation 11 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6797; 16 Nov 2001 p. 5990; 8 Jan 2002 p. 38; 17 Oct 2017 p. 5339; SL 2020/184 r. 5; SL 2020/253 r. 7.]

11A.“When blank” signs

(1)In this regulation —

“when blank” sign means a sign that is substantially rectangular in shape and —

(a)is displayed or erected on or near a carriageway in conjunction with at least one variable illuminated sign that is, when operational, used as a speed limit sign (whether or not the sign is also used as a traffic‑control signal) (a corresponding illuminated speed sign); and

(b)consists of the following upon a white background —

(i)black numerals set within a white circle with a red outline;

(ii)the words “when all signs blank” or “when sign blank”.

When blank signs

When all signs blank

(circle in red)

When sign blank

(circle in red)

(2)A “when blank” sign is taken to be a speed limit sign for the purposes of these regulations if the corresponding illuminated speed sign is blank (or, if there is more than one corresponding illuminated speed sign, all of the corresponding illuminated speed signs are blank).

(3)A “when blank” sign is not a speed limit sign for the purposes of these regulations if the corresponding illuminated speed sign is not blank (or, if there is more than one corresponding illuminated speed sign, any of the corresponding illuminated speed signs are not blank).

[Regulation 11A inserted: SL 2020/184 r. 6.]

12.Minimum speeds on freeways

(1)In a freeway speed zone, a person must not drive a vehicle at a speed that is more than 20 km/h below the speed limit applicable to the zone unless —

(a)traffic congestion prevents the person from driving the vehicle at a speed that is within 21 km/h of the speed limit; or

(b)for any other reason, it is unsafe or imprudent for the person to drive the vehicle at a speed that is within 21 km/h of the speed limit.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)For the purposes of subregulation (1), if the vehicle is in a freeway speed zone that begins with a variable illuminated speed limit sign, the reference to the speed limit applicable to the zone is taken to be a reference to the speed limit applicable to the zone when the vehicle enters the zone.

[Regulation 12 amended: Gazette 17 Oct 2017 p. 5339; SL 2020/184 r. 7; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

13.Heavy vehicles and vehicles towing trailers

(1)This regulation is subject to any other provisions of these regulations prescribing a maximum speed for any vehicle lower than that prescribed by this regulation.

(2)A person must not drive a vehicle to which a trailer or other vehicle is attached at a speed exceeding 100 km/h.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

(3)A person must not drive a vehicle, the GVM of which, taking into account any trailer attached and including the total load carried, is more than 12 t, at a speed exceeding 100 km/h.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

(4)A person must not drive a bus with a GVM over 5 t at a speed exceeding 100 km/h.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

(5)The several speeds prescribed by this regulation apply to the respective classes of vehicle therein mentioned, notwithstanding the existence of speed zones that permit higher speeds for other classes of vehicles.

[Regulation 13 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

14.Heavy vehicle speed zones

A person must not drive a heavy vehicle in a heavy vehicle speed zone at a speed exceeding the speed limit applicable to the zone.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

[Regulation 14 amended: Gazette 17 Oct 2017 p. 5339; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

[15.Deleted: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6758.]

16.Speed restriction on bridge

Where a traffic sign is erected near a bridge to face an approaching driver, then if the sign is inscribed with the words, “Speed Limit on Bridge”, followed by numerals and the letters “km/h” the driver must not exceed the speed indicated by the sign, while he or she is between it and the far end of the bridge.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 17.

[Regulation 16 amended: Gazette 17 Oct 2017 p. 5340; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

17.Penalties for speeding

(1)Subject to regulation 17(2), the following points and modified penalties apply for the offences in this Part that refer to this regulation for their penalty.

Description

Points

Modified penalty

Exceeding a speed limit by —

 

 

(a)

not more than 9 km/h

 

2 PU

(b)

more than 9 km/h but not more than 19 km/h —

 

 

(i)during a holiday period

4

4 PU

(ii)other than during a holiday period


2


4 PU

(c)

more than 19 km/h but not more than 29 km/h —

 

 

(i)during a holiday period

6

8 PU

(ii)other than during a holiday period


3


8 PU

(d)

more than 29 km/h but not more than 40 km/h —

 

 

(i)during a holiday period

12

16 PU

(ii)other than during a holiday period


6


16 PU

(e)

more than 40 km/h —

 

 

(i)during a holiday period

14

24 PU

(ii)other than during a holiday period


7


24 PU

(2)Despite regulation 17(1), the following points and modified penalties apply for the offences in this Part that refer to this regulation for their penalty if the offence is committed by the driver of a heavy vehicle.

Description

Points

Modified penalty

Exceeding a speed limit by —

 

 

(a)

not more than 9 km/h

 

4 PU

(b)

more than 9 km/h but not more than 19 km/h —

 

 

(i)during a holiday period

4

6 PU

(ii)other than during a holiday period


2


6 PU

(c)

more than 19 km/h but not more than 29 km/h —

 

 

(i)during a holiday period

6

10 PU

(ii)other than during a holiday period


3


10 PU

(d)

more than 29 km/h but not more than 40 km/h —

 

 

(i)during a holiday period

12

24 PU

(ii)other than during a holiday period


6


24 PU

(e)

more than 40 km/h —

 

 

(i)during a holiday period

14

30 PU

(ii)other than during a holiday period


7


30 PU

[Regulation 17 inserted: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5817‑18; amended: Gazette 29 Feb 2008 p. 694-5; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3244 and 3247; 25 Jul 2017 p. 4080.]

18.Reckless driving generally

The provisions of this Part do not justify a driver driving at a speed that —

(a)may constitute driving carelessly, recklessly or at a speed, or in a manner, that is dangerous to the public, having regard to all the circumstances; or

(b)exceeds any maximum speed applicable to the vehicle under a road law.

[Regulation 18 amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4920.]

18A.Evasive action in relation to speed camera

(1)In this regulation —

average speed detection system has the meaning given in the Road Traffic (Administration) Act 2008 section 117B(1);

speed measuring and recording equipment has the meaning given in the Road Traffic (Administration) Act 2008 section 117(1).

(2)A person must not drive a motor vehicle on a road if the vehicle is fitted with any device or other equipment that would prevent or adversely affect the operation of speed measuring and recording equipment or an average speed detection system.

Points:

(a)during a holiday period: 14

(b)other than during a holiday period: 7

Modified penalty:

(a)when driving a heavy vehicle: 30 PU

(b)when driving a motor vehicle other than a heavy vehicle: 24 PU

(3)A person must not drive a motor vehicle on a road in a manner that would prevent or adversely affect the operation of speed measuring and recording equipment or an average speed detection system.

Points:

(a)during a holiday period: 14

(b)other than during a holiday period: 7

Modified penalty:

(a)when driving a heavy vehicle: 30 PU

(b)when driving a motor vehicle other than a heavy vehicle: 24 PU

(4)A person who commits an offence against regulation 109, 112, 116, 117 or 129 (a road positioning offence) is taken to have also committed an offence against subregulation (3) if the road positioning offence is committed within 100 m of —

(a)speed measuring and recording equipment; or

(b)the detection points, as defined in the Road Traffic (Administration) Act 2008 section 117B(1), for an average speed detection system.

[Regulation 18A inserted: Gazette 17 Oct 2017 p. 5340‑1.]

Part 4Making turns

Division 1Left turns at intersections

19.Application of Division

This Division applies to a driver making a left turn at an intersection and, where specifically expressed to do so, applies to a driver entering a roundabout.

20.Left turns (single lanes)

(1)A driver who is about to make a left turn from a carriageway (other than a multi‑lane carriageway) at an intersection must drive the vehicle so that when it reaches the intersection it is as near as practicable to the left edge or boundary of the carriageway.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Starting a left turn from a carriageway (except a multi‑lane carriageway)

(2)Subregulation (1) also applies to a rider of a bicycle who approaches and enters an intersection from a bicycle storage area.

(3)Despite subregulation (1), if there is space in a bicycle storage area for 2 riders of bicycles to be next to each other, the rider on the right may approach and enter the intersection as near as practicable to the right side of the other rider, but only if that other rider approaches and enters the intersection in accordance with this regulation.

[Regulation 20 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4564‑5; SL 2020/253 r. 8.]

21.Left turns (multiple lanes)

(1)A driver turning left at an intersection or a roundabout from a multi‑lane carriageway must approach and enter the intersection or roundabout from within the left lane unless —

(a)the driver is required or permitted to approach and enter the intersection from within another marked lane under regulation 69, 73, or 137; or

(b)the driver is turning, at B lights or traffic arrows, in accordance with Part 17; or

(c)subregulation (2) applies to the driver.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example for subregulation (1)(a)

Starting a left turn on a multi‑lane carriageway with traffic lane arrows

(2A)A driver turning left at an intersection from a multi‑lane road that has a slip lane must approach and enter the intersection from within the slip lane, unless an obstruction prevents the driver from entering the intersection from within that slip lane.

Points: 2Modified Penalty: 2 PU

(2)A driver may approach and enter the intersection or roundabout from the marked lane next to the left lane as well as, or instead of, the left lane if —

(a)the driver’s vehicle or combination, together with any load or projection, is 7.5 m long, or longer; and

(b)the rearmost part of the vehicle (or of the combination, if that is the case) displays a “do not overtake turning vehicle” sign; and

(c)any part of the vehicle is within 50 m of the nearest point of the intersection; and

(d)it is not practicable for the driver to turn left from within the left lane; and

(e)the driver can safely occupy the next marked lane and can safely turn left at the intersection by occupying the next marked lane, or both lanes.

Example

Long vehicle turning left from the left lane and next marked lane

(3A)If there is a bicycle storage area before an intersection that extends across one or more marked lanes of a multi‑lane carriageway, a rider of a bicycle turning left must approach and enter the intersection from within the part of the bicycle storage area that is directly in front of the left marked lane, or of a bicycle lane or shoulder that is on the left side of the carriageway.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)In this regulation —

left lane means —

(a)the lane nearest to the far left side of the carriageway; or

(b)if there is an obstruction (for example, a parked car or roadworks) in that lane — the lane nearest to that lane that is not obstructed,

but does not include a special purpose lane in which the driver is not permitted to drive.

Do not overtake turning vehicle signs

(background in yellow)(top right portion in red, remainder of

background in yellow)

 

[Regulation 21 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6752‑3; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4565; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

22.Making left turn as indicated by turn line

(1)Subject to subregulations (2) and (3), if a driver is turning left at an intersection and there is a turn line indicating how the turn is to be made from the lane the driver is in, the driver must make the turn as indicated by the turn line.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Making a left turn as indicated by a turn line

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply to the driver of a public bus at an intersection if the driver is turning, at B lights or a traffic control signal, in accordance with Part 17.

(3)A driver may turn left at an intersection in a manner other than that indicated by a turn line if —

(a)the driver’s vehicle or combination, together with any load or projection, is 7.5 m long, or longer; and

(b)the rearmost part of the vehicle (or of the combination, if that is the case) displays a “do not overtake turning vehicle” sign; and

(c)it is not practicable for the driver to turn left in the manner indicated by the turn line; and

(d)the driver can safely turn left other than by the manner indicated by the turn line.

[Regulation 22 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4566‑7; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 2Right turns (other than hook turns) at intersections

23.Application of Division

This Division applies to a driver making a right turn at an intersection and, where specifically expressed to do so, at a roundabout, but does not apply to —

(a)the rider of a bicycle making a hook turn under Division 3;

(b)a driver making a U turn.

24.Right turns (two‑way, single lanes)

(1)A driver who is about to make a right turn from a two‑way carriageway (other than a multi‑lane carriageway) at an intersection must approach and enter the intersection —

(a)so that the vehicle is to the left of, parallel with, and as near as practicable to, the centre of the carriageway; or

(b)if the carriageway has a dividing line or median strip — so that the vehicle is to the left of, parallel to, and as near as practicable to, the dividing line or median strip.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Starting a right turn from a carriageway with a dividing line

(2)A driver making a right turn at an intersection where the carriageway being entered is a two‑way carriageway must make the turn —

(a)so that, wherever practicable, the vehicle passes to his or her right of the centre of the intersection; and

(b)so that the vehicle enters the carriageway to his or her left of the centre of the carriageway.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)For the purposes of subregulations (2) and (4), a vehicle is deemed to enter a carriageway at the point where the front of the vehicle crosses the prolongation of the edge of the carriageway it is leaving.

(4)Subregulations (1) and (2) also apply to the rider of a bicycle who approaches and enters an intersection from a bicycle storage area.

(5)Despite subregulations (1), (2) and (3), if there is space in a bicycle storage area for 2 riders of bicycles to be next to each other, the rider on the left may approach and enter the intersection as near as practicable to the left side of the other rider, but only if that other rider approaches and enters the intersection in accordance with this regulation.

[Regulation 24 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4567; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

25.Right turns (one‑way, single lanes)

(1)A driver who is about to make a right turn from a one‑way carriageway (other than a multi‑lane carriageway) at an intersection must approach and enter the intersection so that the vehicle is parallel with, and as near as practicable to, the right boundary of the carriageway.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Starting a right turn from a one‑way carriageway

(2)A driver making a right turn at an intersection where the carriageway being entered is a one‑way carriageway must make the turn so that, wherever practicable, the vehicle passes to his or her right of the centre of the intersection.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)For the purposes of subregulation (2), a vehicle is deemed to enter a carriageway at the point where the front of the vehicle crosses the prolongation of the edge of the carriageway it is leaving.

[Regulation 25 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

26.Right turns from multi‑lane carriageway

(1)A driver turning right at an intersection or a roundabout from a multi‑lane carriageway must approach and enter the intersection or roundabout from within the right lane unless —

(a)the driver is required or permitted to approach and enter the intersection from within another marked lane in accordance with regulation 70 or 73; or

(b)the driver is turning, at B lights or traffic arrows, in accordance with Part 17; and

(c)subregulation (2) applies to the driver.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example for subregulation (1)(a)

Starting a right turn on a multi‑lane carriageway with traffic lane arrows

(2)A driver may approach and enter the intersection or roundabout from the marked lane next to the right lane as well as, or instead of, the right lane if —

(a)the driver’s vehicle or combination, together with any load or projection, is 7.5 m long, or longer; and

(b)the rearmost part of the vehicle (or of the combination, if that is the case) displays a “do not overtake turning vehicle” sign; and

(c)any part of the vehicle is within 50 m of the nearest point of the intersection; and

(d)it is not practicable for the driver to turn right from within the right lane; and

(e)the driver can safely occupy the next marked lane and can safely turn right at the intersection by occupying the next marked lane, or both lanes.

(3A)If there is a bicycle storage area before an intersection that extends across one or more marked lanes of a multi‑lane carriageway, a rider of a bicycle turning right (but not making a hook turn) must approach and enter the intersection from within the part of the bicycle storage area that is directly in front of the right marked lane or of a bicycle lane that is on the right side of the carriageway.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)In this regulation —

right lane means —

(a)the lane nearest to the dividing line or median strip on the carriageway; or

(b)if there is an obstruction (for example, a parked car or roadworks) in that lane — the lane nearest to that lane that is not obstructed,

but does not include a special purpose lane in which the driver is not permitted to drive.

Do not overtake turning vehicle signs

(background in yellow)(top right portion in red, remainder of

background in yellow)

 

[Regulation 26 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6753; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4567‑8; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

27.Making a right turn (generally)

(1)Despite this Part, a driver who is about to make, or is making, a right turn at an intersection where turn lines or signs are so placed as to indicate that a different course from that specified in this regulation is to be travelled, must not turn the vehicle at the intersection otherwise than as indicated by the turn lines or signs.

Points: 2 Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Making a right turn as indicated by a turn line

(2)If there is no road marking indicating how the turn is required to be made, the driver must make the turn so the vehicle passes as near as practicable to the right of the centre of the intersection and into the left side of the carriageway that is being entered (unless that carriageway is a one‑way carriageway).

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Making a right turn from a carriageway with no road marking indicating how to make the turn

(3A)Subregulations (1) and (2) do not apply to the driver of a public bus at an intersection if the driver is turning, at B lights or traffic arrows, in accordance with Part 17.

(3B)A driver may turn right at an intersection in a manner other than that indicated by a turn line if —

(a)the driver’s vehicle or combination, together with any load or projection, is 7.5 m long, or longer; and

(b)the rearmost part of the vehicle (or of the combination, if that is the case) displays a “do not overtake turning vehicle” sign; and

(c)it is not practicable for the driver to turn right in the manner indicated by the turn line; and

(d)the driver can safely turn right other than by the manner indicated by the turn line.

(3)Despite this Part, a driver who is about to make, or is making, a right turn at an intersection where a police officer is controlling or directing traffic, must make the turn before reaching the middle of the road into which he or she is turning by passing either to the front, or to the rear of, the police officer, as he or she may be directed.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 27 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4568‑9; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4929; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 3Hook turns by bicycles at intersections

28.Optional hook turn by bicycle rider

(1)The rider of a bicycle turning right at an intersection without a “no hook turn by bicycles” sign, may turn right at the intersection by making a right turn or a hook turn.

No hook turn by bicycles sign

(2)A rider of a bicycle must not make a hook turn under this regulation unless it is made in accordance with subregulations (3) and (4).

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)To make a hook turn, a rider of a bicycle must take, in sequence, each of the following steps:

1Approach and enter the intersection in the lane furthest left that allows the rider to ride straight through the intersection and from as near as practicable to the far left side of that lane.

2Move forward —

(a)keeping as near as practicable to the far left side of the intersection; and

(b)keeping clear of any marked foot crossing; and

(c)keeping clear, as far as practicable, of any driver turning left from the left of the intersection,

until the rider is as near as practicable to the far side of the carriageway that the rider is entering.

3If there are traffic‑control signals at the intersection, remain at the position reached under step 2 until the traffic‑control signals on the carriageway that the rider is entering change to green.

4If there are no traffic‑control signals at the intersection, remain at the position reached under step 2 until the rider has given way to approaching drivers on the carriageway that the rider is leaving.

5Turn right into the carriageway that the rider is entering.

Example

Bicycle rider making a hook turn at an intersection without traffic‑control signals

(4)If the rider of a bicycle wants to turn right by making a hook turn at an intersection that has a bicycle hook turn storage area on the left side of the intersection as the rider approaches the intersection, the rider must take the following initial 2 steps instead of the initial 2 steps listed in subregulation (3):

1Approach the intersection from the far left side of the carriageway the rider is leaving and enter the intersection by moving into the bicycle hook turn storage area, keeping clear of any marked foot crossing.

2Move forward in the bicycle hook turn storage area until the rider is as near as practicable to the far side of the carriageway that the rider is entering.

[Regulation 28 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6753; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4569‑70; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

29.Bicycle rider making hook turn contrary to sign

The rider of a bicycle must not make a hook turn at an intersection if a “no hook turn by bicycles” sign applies to the rider.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

No hook turn by bicycles sign

[Regulation 29 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 4U turns

30.U turns on carriageway

(1)A driver must not make a U turn if a “no U turn” sign applies to the portion of carriageway on or at which he or she intends to make that U turn.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

No U turn signs

No U turn sign
(Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

No U turn sign
(Variable illuminated message sign)

(circle and slash illuminated in red)

(2)A “no U turn” sign on a carriageway (except a “no U turn” sign at an intersection or at a break in a median strip) applies to the length of carriageway beginning at the sign and ending at the nearer of the following —

(a)the next intersection;

(b)if the carriageway ends at a T‑intersection or dead end — the end of the carriageway.

(3)A “no U turn” sign at an intersection or at a break in a median strip applies to that intersection or break when a driver approaches the intersection or median break from the direction in which the sign is facing.

[Regulation 30 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

31.U turns at intersection

(1)A driver must not make a U turn at an intersection without traffic‑control signals if a “no U turn” sign at the intersection applies to that driver.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

No U turn signs

No U turn sign
(Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

No U turn sign
(Variable illuminated message sign)

(circle and slash illuminated in red)

(2)A driver must not make a U turn at an intersection with traffic‑control signals unless there is a “U turn permitted” sign at the intersection that applies to that driver.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

U turn permitted sign

[Regulation 31 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; 18 Sep 2009 p. 3627; SL 2020/253 r. 9.]

32.U turns generally

(1)A driver must not commence a U turn unless —

(a)the turn can be made with safety and without interfering with the movement of other traffic; and

(b)the driver has a clear view of any approaching traffic.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A driver making a U turn must give way to all vehicles and pedestrians.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)A driver making a U turn must commence the U turn —

(a)if the carriageway where the driver is turning has a dividing line or median strip — from the lane nearest, or as near as practicable, to the dividing line or median strip; or

(b)in any other case — from the left of the centre of the carriageway.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Starting a U turn on a two‑way carriageway with a median strip

[Regulation 32 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 5Turns from a carriageway to land abutting the carriageway

33.Turns to enter abutting land

(1)A driver who is about to make a left turn from a carriageway, to enter land abutting that carriageway, must drive the vehicle so that when it reaches the point at which the turn is to be made it is —

(a)to the left of any vehicle that is abreast of his or her own and travelling in the same direction; and

(b)as near as practicable to the left edge or boundary of the carriageway.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)Subject to subregulation (3), a driver who is about to make a right turn to enter land abutting a carriageway must —

(a)where he or she is travelling on a two‑way carriageway, approach the point at which the turn is to be made so that the vehicle is to the left of, parallel with, and as near as practicable to, the centre of the carriageway; and

(b)where he or she is travelling on a one‑way carriageway, approach the point at which the turn is to be made so that the vehicle is parallel with and as near as practicable to, the right boundary of the carriageway.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)Subregulation (2) does not apply where a vehicle is in a marked lane that has a sign alongside or over it or markings on its surface indicating that a right turn must, or may be, made by vehicles in that lane.

[Regulation 33 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; SL 2020/253 r. 10.]

Part 5 Turning and stop signals

34.Terms used

(1)In this Part, a driver is turning left if the driver is doing any of the following:

(a)turning left;

(b)changing lanes to the left;

(c)diverging to the left, including diverging to the left from a straight line of travel within a marked lane or within a line of traffic;

(ca)moving to the left in order to start, or stop, lane filtering in accordance with regulation 130B;

(d)entering a marked lane, or a line of traffic, to the left;

(e)moving to the left from a stationary position;

(f)turning left into a marked lane, or a line of traffic, from a median strip parking area;

(g)at a T‑intersection where the continuing road curves to the right — leaving the continuing road to proceed straight ahead onto the terminating road.

(2)In this Part, a driver is turning right if the driver is doing any of the following:

(a)turning right;

(b)changing marked lanes to the right;

(c)diverging to the right, including diverging to the right from a straight line of travel within a marked lane or within a line of traffic;

(ca)moving to the right in order to start, or stop, lane filtering in accordance with regulation 130B;

(d)entering a marked lane, or a line of traffic, to the right;

(e)moving to the right from a stationary position;

(f)turning right into a marked lane, or a line of traffic, from a median strip parking area;

(g)making a U turn;

(h)at a T‑intersection where the continuing road curves to the left — leaving the continuing road to proceed straight ahead onto the terminating road.

(3)In this Part, a rider is not taken to be turning right if the rider is making a hook turn in accordance with regulation 28.

[Regulation 34 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 11.]

35.When drivers are to give signals

A driver must not turn right or left, or stop or suddenly decrease speed, without giving warning of his or her intentions, by a signal as prescribed by this Part.

[Regulation 35 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6753; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

36.How drivers are to give signals

(1)A driver who is required to give a signal of intention to turn right or left, or to drive a public bus out from a bus embayment must, where the vehicle is equipped with the appropriate flashing light signalling device or illuminated indicator in working order, give the signal by means of that flashing light signalling device or illuminated indicator.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A driver who is required to give a signal of intention to turn right must, where the vehicle is not equipped with an appropriate flashing light signalling device or illuminated indicator in working order, give the signal —

(a)by means of a hand‑shaped signalling device; or

(b)by fully extending his or her right arm and hand horizontally beyond the right side of the vehicle and approximately at right angles to the centre line of the vehicle.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Giving a hand signal for turning (inc. diverging) to the right

(3)A rider of a bicycle who is required to give a signal of intention to turn left, must give a signal by fully extending his or her left arm and hand horizontally beyond the left side of the vehicle and approximately at right angles to the centre line of the vehicle.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)A driver who is required to give a signal of intention to stop or to reduce speed suddenly must, where the vehicle is equipped with a stop light or lights in working order, give the signal by means of that stop light or those lights.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(5)A driver who is required to give a signal of intention to stop or to reduce speed suddenly must, where the vehicle is not equipped with a stop light or lights in working order, give the signal —

(a)by means of a hand‑shaped signalling device; or

(b)by extending his or her right arm beyond the right side of the vehicle with the upper arm horizontal and the forearm and fingers pointing upwards.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Giving a hand signal for stopping or reducing speed suddenly

(6)Despite subregulation (5), the rider of a motor cycle may give the hand signal to stop or to reduce speed suddenly by extending the left arm and hand at right angles from the left side of the motor cycle, with the upper arm horizontal and the forearm and hand pointing upwards, and with the hand open and the palm facing the direction of travel.

(7)Nothing in this regulation —

(a)prevents a driver who complies with subregulation (1) or (4) from also giving the arm and hand signal that he or she would be required to give if the vehicle were not equipped with the appropriate flashing light signalling device, illuminated indicator or stop light or lights as the case may be; or

(b)requires the driver of a vehicle, which is not a bicycle, to give a signal of intention to turn left if the vehicle is not equipped with a flashing light signalling device or illuminated indicator capable of being used to give such a signal.

[Regulation 36 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

37.How long should hand signals be given

(1)A driver must give —

(a)a signal to turn right or left; or

(b)any signal required to be given where a vehicle is not equipped with a flashing light signalling device or illuminated indicator capable of being used to give such a signal,

for long enough to give sufficient warning to other drivers and pedestrians.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)In addition to subregulation (1), a driver must give a signal prescribed by this Part, where he or she intends —

(a)to join a line of traffic and the vehicle is stationary at the side of a carriageway, or in a centre of the road parking area — continuously for 5 seconds before pulling out; and

(b)to stop or suddenly reduce speed — while the brakes are being applied; and

(c)to drive a public bus away from a bus embayment or from the side of a carriageway — for at least 5 seconds.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 37 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

38.Use of signalling devices

(1)A driver must not permit a signalling device to be operated, except for the purpose of giving a signal in accordance with the provisions of these regulations (including operation as part of the vehicle’s hazard warning lights).

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A driver must not permit a signalling device on the vehicle to remain in operation after the completion of the turn in respect of which the device was put into operation.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 38 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 6Traffic‑control signals (traffic lights and twin alternating red lights)

Division 1Obeying traffic‑control signals (traffic lights)

39.Proceeding when faced with circular green signal or green arrow

(1)If a traffic‑control signal facing a driver displays a circular green signal, the driver must, in accordance with these regulations and if it is safe to do so —

(a)proceed straight ahead; or

(b)turn left; or

(c)turn right (including making a U turn if permitted).

Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)Subregulation (3) applies if a traffic‑control signal facing a driver displays a green arrow signal and the driver is turning in the direction indicated by that arrow.

(3)The driver must, in accordance with these regulations and if it is safe to do so, proceed in the direction indicated by the arrow (including making a U turn if permitted).

Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 39 inserted: SL 2020/253 r. 12.]

39A.Effect of traffic‑control signal accompanied by “one vehicle per green each lane” sign

(1)This regulation applies if —

(a)there is a traffic‑control signal facing a driver; and

(b)there is a “one vehicle per green each lane” sign at or near the traffic‑control signal.

One vehicle per green each lane sign

(2)If the traffic‑control signal displays a circular green signal, the driver —

(a)must not turn right or left; and

(b)except as provided in subregulation (3), must not proceed straight ahead past the signal if another vehicle in the same lane has proceeded past the signal since the signal last changed to green.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)Two vehicles in the same lane may proceed past the traffic‑control signal displaying a circular green signal if —

(a)the two vehicles were side by side when they were at the signal; and

(b)at least one of the vehicles is a motor cycle; and

(c)the vehicles are the first two vehicles in that lane to proceed past the signal since the signal last changed to green.

(4)If the traffic‑control signal does not display a signal, the driver may proceed straight ahead past the signal and any stop line at or near the signal, as if the traffic‑control signal and the stop line were not there.

[Regulation 39A inserted: SL 2020/184 r. 9.]

40.Stopping for circular red signal or red arrow

(1)Except as provided in regulations 42, 43 and 43A, if a traffic‑control signal facing a driver displays a circular red signal —

(a)if there is a stop line at or near the signal, the driver must stop as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the stop line and must not proceed beyond the stop line; or

(b)if there is a “stop here on red signal” sign at or near the signal, but no stop line, the driver must stop as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the sign and must not proceed beyond the sign; or

(c)in the absence of a stop line, the driver —

(i)must stop as near as practicable to but before reaching the nearest appropriate traffic‑control signal and must not proceed beyond the signal; and

(ii)must not enter a marked foot crossing.

Points:

(a)during a holiday period: 6;

(b)other than during a holiday period: 3.

Modified penalty: 6 PU.

 

Stop here on red signal sign

(writing and edging in red)

Example for subregulation (1)(a)

Stopping at a stop here on red signal sign on a road the driver is entering

(2)If a traffic‑control signal facing a driver displays a red arrow signal and the driver is turning in the direction indicated by that arrow —

(a)if there is a stop line at or near the signal, the driver must stop as near as practicable to, but before reaching the stop line and must not proceed beyond the stop line; or

(b)if there is a “stop here on red arrow” sign at or near the signal, but no stop line, the driver must stop as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the sign and must not proceed beyond the sign; or

(c)in the absence of a stop line, the driver —

(i)must stop as near as practicable to but before reaching the nearest appropriate traffic‑control signal and must not proceed beyond the signal; and

(ii)must not enter a marked foot crossing,

as the case may be, in the direction indicated by the arrow.

Points:

(a)during a holiday period: 6;

(b)other than during a holiday period: 3.

Modified penalty: 6 PU.

Stop here on red arrow sign

(writing and edging in red)

(3)If there is a bicycle storage area before any traffic‑control signal referred to in subregulation (1) or (2), a reference to the stop line in subregulation (1)(a) or (2)(a) —

(a)in the case of a driver of a motor vehicle, is a reference to the first stop line that the driver comes to, or came to, in approaching the signal;

(b)in the case of a rider of a bicycle, is a reference to the stop line that is nearest to the intersection.

[Regulation 40 inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4570‑3; amended: Gazette 4 Apr 2014 p. 885; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3244; SL 2020/253 r. 13.]

41A.Motor vehicles not to enter bicycle storage area

(1)If there is a bicycle storage area before a traffic‑control signal that is showing a circular red signal, the driver of a motor vehicle must not allow any part of the vehicle to enter the bicycle storage area.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)If there is a bicycle storage area before a traffic‑control signal that is showing a red arrow signal, and the driver of a motor vehicle is turning in the direction indicated by that arrow, the driver must not allow any part of the vehicle to enter the bicycle storage area.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 41A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4573; amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3244; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

41.Stopping for circular yellow signal or yellow arrow

(1)Except as provided in regulations 42 and 43A, if a traffic‑control signal facing a driver displays a steady circular yellow signal or a yellow arrow, the driver must not proceed beyond the stop line associated with the signal or the stop line of the lane associated with the signal or in the absence of a stop line, at a point adjacent to the nearest appropriate traffic‑control signal, unless the driver is so close to the stop line, or traffic‑control signal, when the circular yellow signal or yellow arrow first appears, that the driver cannot safely stop the vehicle before passing over the stop line.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)Except as provided in regulations 42 and 43A, if a traffic‑control signal facing a driver displays a steady circular yellow signal or a yellow arrow and the driver cannot safely stop the vehicle in accordance with subregulation (1), but can stop safely before entering the intersection, the driver must stop before entering the intersection.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)If a traffic‑control signal facing a driver displays a steady circular yellow signal or a yellow arrow and the driver is not able to stop safely under subregulation (1) or (2), and enters the intersection, the driver must leave the intersection as soon as the driver can do so safely.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(4)If there is a bicycle storage area before a traffic‑control signal referred to in subregulation (1), a reference to the stop line —

(a)in the case of a driver of a motor vehicle, is a reference to the first stop line that the driver comes to, or came to, in approaching the signal;

(b)in the case of a rider of a bicycle, is a reference to the stop line that is nearest to the intersection.

[Regulation 41 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4573‑4; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3243 and 3244; SL 2020/253 r. 14.]

42.Green arrow with red or yellow signal, effect of

If a traffic‑control signal facing a driver displays a green arrow, in conjunction with a circular red or yellow signal, the driver may proceed, but only in the direction indicated by the arrow.

43.Turning left on red signal

Despite regulation 40, a driver may turn left at an intersection —

(a)at which there is a traffic‑control signal facing the driver and displaying a circular red signal, alone; and

(b)at or near which there is a “left turn on red permitted after stopping” sign,

if —

(c)before starting to make the turn, the driver —

(i)stops the vehicle as near as possible to, but without passing over, the stop line associated with the traffic‑control signal; or

(ii)in the absence of a stop line, stops the vehicle, without entering the intersection, at a point adjacent to the nearest appropriate traffic‑control signal;

and

(d)the driver can make the turn with safety.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

Left turn on red after stopping sign

[Regulation 43 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3244.]

43A.Effect of green bicycle light with red or yellow signals

(1)This regulation applies to the rider of a bicycle who is faced with —

(a)bicycle crossing lights displaying a green bicycle crossing light; and

(b)either or both of the following —

(i)a traffic‑control signal displaying a circular red signal or a steady circular yellow signal;

(ii)a traffic‑control signal displaying a red arrow signal or a yellow arrow signal.

(2)Despite regulations 40 and 41, the rider may proceed straight ahead.

[Regulation 43A inserted: SL 2020/253 r. 15.]

43B.Effect of red bicycle light with green arrow signal

(1)This regulation applies to the rider of a bicycle approaching an intersection on a carriageway if —

(a)the rider is in a bicycle lane to the far left side of the carriageway; and

(b)drivers entering the intersection from the marked lane next to the bicycle lane must only turn left.

(2)Despite regulation 225, if the rider is faced with both a traffic‑control signal displaying a green arrow signal pointing left and bicycle crossing lights displaying a red bicycle crossing light, the rider may proceed, but only in the direction indicated by the arrow.

[Regulation 43B inserted: SL 2020/253 r. 15.]

44.What to do if signals change when intersection congested etc.

(1)This regulation applies to a driver —

(a)if a traffic‑control signal facing the driver displays a circular green signal at an intersection and the driver has stopped after the stop line, “stop here on red signal” sign, or nearest or only traffic lights, at the intersection; or

(b)if a traffic‑control signal facing the driver at an intersection displays a green traffic arrow and the driver is turning in the direction indicated by the arrow but the driver has stopped after the stop line, “stop here on red arrow” sign, or nearest or only traffic arrows, at the intersection.

(2)Subject to this regulation, if the traffic‑control signals change to yellow or red while a driver is stopped and the driver has not fully entered the intersection, the driver must not begin to enter the intersection, or proceed further into the intersection.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)Despite subregulation (2) —

(a)if the traffic‑control signals are at an intersection with a “left turn on red after stopping” sign and the driver is turning left at the intersection, the driver may turn left after stopping;

(b)if a traffic‑control signal facing the driver at an intersection changes, to display a circular red signal, but a green traffic arrow is also displayed and the driver is turning in the direction indicated by the arrow, the driver may continue to turn in the direction of the arrow if safe to do so.

(4)If the traffic‑control signals change to yellow or red while the driver is stopped and the driver has fully entered the intersection, the driver must leave the intersection as soon as the driver can do so safely.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 44 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3243, 3244 and 3247; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 2Giving way at traffic‑control signals (traffic lights)

45.Right of way during turns at intersection with traffic‑control signals

(1)A driver who intends to turn, is turning or has turned, right at an intersection with traffic‑control signals must give way to any oncoming vehicle that is going straight ahead or turning left at the intersection (except a vehicle turning left using a slip lane).

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(2)A driver who intends to turn, is turning or has turned, left at an intersection with traffic‑control signals and a “left turn on red after stopping” sign must give way to any vehicle approaching from the right, turning right at the intersection into the carriageway the driver is entering or making a U turn at the intersection.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)A driver turning to the right or left (except a driver turning left using a slip lane) at an intersection with traffic‑control signals must give way to all pedestrians who are crossing the carriageway, or part of the carriageway, the driver is entering.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

Examples

Example 1

Giving way to a pedestrian on the carriageway the driver is entering

Example 2

Driver turning right giving way to an oncoming vehicle going straight ahead

Example 3

Driver turning right does not have to give way to an oncoming vehicle that is turning left into the carriageway the driver is entering using a slip lane

(4)Subregulation (1) does not apply to a driver turning right at an intersection in accordance with a green traffic arrow.

[Regulation 45 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4574; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5750; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3244‑5; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

46.Giving way at intersection with traffic‑control signals not operating or only partly operating

(1)If all the traffic‑control signals facing a driver approaching an intersection do not appear to be functioning, or are displaying a flashing yellow signal, and there is a traffic light‑stop sign, the driver must treat that intersection as if the driver were facing a “stop” sign and no traffic‑control signals under regulation 50.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 5 PU

Traffic light‑stop sign

(background in red)

(2)If all the traffic‑control signals facing a driver approaching an intersection do not appear to be functioning, or display a flashing yellow signal and there is no traffic light‑stop sign facing the driver, the driver must treat that intersection as if the driver were at an intersection under regulation 55 or a T‑intersection under regulation 56, as the case requires, that is not controlled by traffic‑control signals or does not have a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign, or give way line that applies to the driver.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 5 PU

(3)Despite subregulations (1) and (2), a driver may only proceed beyond the stop line associated with traffic‑control signals facing a driver that do not appear to be functioning, or display flashing yellow signals, or (in the absence of a stop line) beyond a point adjacent to the nearest signals, if the driver —

[(a)deleted]

(b)does not turn the vehicle contrary to an instruction on a traffic sign at the intersection; and

[(c)deleted]

(d)complies with any direction by a police officer, if a police officer is in attendance regulating traffic.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

(4)Subregulation (3) does not apply if the intersection is a roundabout.

[Regulation 46 amended: Gazette 8 Feb 2008 p. 316-17; 4 Jun 2010 p. 2398; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4929; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

47.Giving way at flashing yellow traffic arrow at intersection

A driver turning in the direction indicated by a flashing yellow traffic arrow at an intersection with traffic‑control signals must give way to —

(a)any vehicle travelling on the carriageway the driver is entering; and

(b)any pedestrian at or near the intersection who is crossing the carriageway the driver is entering; and

(c)if the driver is turning right — any oncoming vehicle that is going straight ahead or turning left at the intersection (except a vehicle turning left using a slip lane).

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 47 amended: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5750; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

48.Giving way at crossing (other than at intersection) with flashing yellow traffic‑control signal

If a driver is approaching or at a marked foot crossing (except at or near an intersection) with a flashing yellow traffic‑control signal at the crossing, the driver must —

(a)give way to any pedestrian on the crossing; and

(b)not obstruct any pedestrian on the crossing; and

(c)not pass a vehicle that is travelling in the same direction as the driver and is stopping, or has stopped, to give way at the crossing.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 48 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 3Twin alternating red lights

49.Stopping for twin alternating red lights (except at level crossings)

(1)If a driver is approaching or at a traffic‑control signal displaying twin alternating red lights (other than at a level crossing) and there is a stop line at or near the lights and the driver can stop safely before reaching the stop line, the driver must stop as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the stop line.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

(2)If a driver is approaching or at a traffic‑control signal displaying twin alternating red lights (other than at a level crossing) and there is no stop line at or near the lights and the driver can stop safely before reaching the lights, the driver must stop as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the lights.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

(3)If a driver stops for a traffic‑control signal displaying twin alternating red lights, the driver must not proceed until the lights are not showing.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

[Regulation 49 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 7Giving way

Division 1Places with a stop sign, stop line, give way sign or give way line applying to the driver

50.Stopping and giving way at stop sign or stop line at intersection without traffic‑control signals

(1)This regulation does not apply to a driver approaching or at an intersection if the intersection is controlled by traffic‑control signals.

(2)A driver approaching or at an intersection with a “stop” sign or stop line must stop as near as practicable to, but —

(a)before reaching the stop line; or

(b)if there is no stop line — before entering the intersection.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

Stop sign


(background in red)

(3)A driver approaching or at an intersection with a “stop” sign or stop line must give way to a vehicle in, entering or approaching the intersection except —

(a)an oncoming vehicle turning right at the intersection, if a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign or give way line applies to the driver of the oncoming vehicle; or

(b)a vehicle turning left at the intersection using a slip lane; or

(c)a vehicle making a U turn.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(4)If a driver at an intersection with a “stop” sign or stop line is turning left or right or making a U turn, the driver must also give way to any pedestrian at or near the intersection who is crossing the carriageway, or part of the carriageway, the driver is entering.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(5)If a driver at an intersection is turning left using a slip lane with a “stop” sign or stop line, the driver must give way to any pedestrian on the slip lane.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(6)In this regulation, an oncoming vehicle travelling through a T‑intersection on the continuing carriageway is taken not to be turning.

Examples

Example 1

Stop line

Example 2

Stopping and giving way at a stop sign to a vehicle on the right

In example 2, vehicle B must stop and give way to vehicle A.

[Regulation 50 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4574; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5751; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

51.Stopping and giving way at stop sign or stop line at other places

(1)This regulation does not apply to a driver if the driver is approaching or at an intersection, children’s crossing, level crossing, or a place with twin alternating red lights.

(2)A driver approaching or at a place with a “stop” sign or stop line must stop as near as practicable to, but —

(a)before reaching the stop line; or

(b)if there is no stop line — before entering the intersection.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)A driver approaching or at a place with a “stop” sign or stop line must give way to any vehicle or pedestrian at or near the “stop” sign or stop line.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

Examples

Example 1

Stopping and giving way at a stop sign at a break in a dividing strip

Example 2

Stopping and giving way at a stop sign where a carpark exit joins a carriageway

In each example, vehicle B must stop and give way to vehicle A.

[Regulation 51 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4575; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

52.Giving way at give way sign or give way line at intersection

(1)A driver at an intersection with a “give way” sign or give way line must give way to a vehicle in, entering or approaching the intersection except —

(a)an oncoming vehicle turning right at the intersection, if a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign or give way line applies to the driver of the oncoming vehicle; or

(b)a vehicle turning left at the intersection using a slip lane; or

(c)a vehicle making a U turn.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Give way sign

(triangle in red)

(2)If a driver at an intersection with a “give way” sign or give way line is turning left or right or making a U turn, the driver must give way to any pedestrian at or near the intersection who is crossing the carriageway, or part of the carriageway, the driver is entering.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(3)If a driver at an intersection is turning left using a slip lane with a “give way” sign or give way line, the driver must give way to any pedestrian on the slip lane.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(4)In this regulation, an oncoming vehicle travelling through a T‑intersection on the continuing carriageway is taken not to be turning.

Examples

Example 1

Give way line

Example 2

Giving way at a give way sign to a vehicle on the right

In example 2, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

Example 3

Driver turning right at a give way line does not have to give way to a vehicle turning left using a slip lane

In example 3, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

[Regulation 52 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4575; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5751; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

53.Giving way at give way sign at bridge or length of narrow carriageway

The driver of a vehicle approaching a bridge or length of narrow carriageway with a “give way” sign must give way to any oncoming vehicle that is on, or approaching, the bridge or length of carriageway when the driver reaches the sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Examples

Example 1

Giving way at a bridge

Example 2

Giving way at a length of narrow carriageway

In each example, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

[Regulation 53 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; 15 May 2018 p. 1532; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

54.Giving way at give way sign or give way line at other places

(1)This regulation does not apply to a driver if the driver is approaching or at an intersection, children’s crossing, level crossing, or a place with twin alternating red lights.

(2)A driver approaching or at a place with a “give way” sign or give way line must give way to any vehicle or pedestrian at or near the “give way” sign or give way line.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Examples

Example 1

Giving way at a give way sign at a break in a dividing strip

Example 2

Giving way at a give way sign where a bicycle path meets a carriageway

In example 1, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

In example 2, the motor vehicle must give way to the bicycle.

[Regulation 54 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 2Giving way at an intersection without traffic‑control signals or a stop sign, stop line, give way sign or give way line applying to the driver

55.Giving way at intersection (except T‑intersection or roundabout)

(1)This regulation does not apply to a driver at a T‑intersection or roundabout, or at an intersection controlled by traffic‑control signals or with a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign, or give way line that applies to that driver.

(2)If a driver at an intersection is going straight ahead, the driver must give way to any vehicle approaching from the right, unless a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign or give way line applies to the driver of the approaching vehicle.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Examples

Example 1

Driver going straight ahead giving way to a vehicle on the right that is going straight ahead

Example 2

Driver going straight ahead giving way to a vehicle on the right that is turning right

In each example, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

(3)If a driver at an intersection is turning left (except if the driver is using a slip lane), the driver must give way to —

(a)any vehicle approaching from the right, unless a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign or give way line applies to the driver of the approaching vehicle; and

(b)any pedestrian at or near the intersection who is crossing the carriageway the driver is entering.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

Examples

Example 3

Driver turning left giving way to a vehicle on the right that is going straight ahead

Example 4

Driver turning left giving way to a pedestrian on the carriageway the driver is entering

In example 3, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

In example 4, the vehicle must give way to the pedestrian.

(4)If a driver at an intersection is turning left using a slip lane, the driver must give way to any vehicle approaching from the right or turning right at the intersection into the carriageway the driver is entering (except a vehicle making a U turn at the intersection).

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(5)If a driver at an intersection is turning left using a slip lane, the driver must give way to any pedestrian on the slip lane.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

Example

Example 5

Driver turning left using a slip lane giving way to a vehicle
that is turning right into the carriageway the driver is entering

In this example, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

(6)If a driver at an intersection is turning right, the driver must give way to —

(a)any vehicle approaching from the right unless a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign or give way line applies to the driver of the approaching vehicle; and

(b)any oncoming vehicle that is going straight ahead or turning left at the intersection unless —

(i)a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign, or give way line applies to the driver of the oncoming vehicle; or

(ii)the oncoming vehicle is turning left using a slip lane;

and

(c)any pedestrian at or near the intersection who is crossing the carriageway the driver is entering.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

Examples

Example 6

Driver turning right giving way to a vehicle on the right that is turning right into the carriageway the driver is leaving

Example 7

Driver turning right giving way to an oncoming vehicle that is going straight ahead on the carriageway the driver is leaving

In examples 6 and 7, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

Example 8

Driver turning right giving way to an oncoming vehicle that is turning left into the carriageway the driver is entering

Example 9

Driver turning right giving way to a pedestrian on the carriageway the driver is entering

In example 8, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

In example 9, the vehicle must give way to the pedestrian.

[Regulation 55 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4575; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5751; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

56.Giving way at T‑intersection

(1)This regulation applies to a driver at a T‑intersection that is not controlled by traffic‑control signals, or does not have a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign, or give way line, that applies to that driver.

(2)If a driver at a T‑intersection is turning left (except if the driver is using a slip lane), or right, from the terminating road into the continuing road, the driver must give way to —

(a)any vehicle travelling on the continuing road (except a vehicle making a U turn on the terminating road at the intersection); and

(b)any pedestrian who is crossing the continuing road at or near the intersection.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Examples

Example 1

Driver turning right from the terminating road giving way to a vehicle on the continuing road

Example 2

Driver turning left (except if the driver is using a slip lane) from the terminating road giving way to a pedestrian on the continuing road

In example 1, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

In example 2, the vehicle must give way to the pedestrian.

(3)If a driver at a T‑intersection is turning left from the terminating road into the continuing road using a slip lane, the driver must give way to —

(a)any vehicle travelling on the continuing road (except a vehicle making a U turn on the continuing road at the intersection); and

(b)any pedestrian on the slip lane.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(4)If a driver at a T‑intersection is turning left (except if the driver is using a slip lane) from the continuing road into the terminating road, the driver must give way to any pedestrian who is crossing the terminating road at or near the intersection.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Example

Example 3

Driver turning left (except if the driver is using a slip lane) from the continuing road giving way to a pedestrian on the terminating road

In this example, the vehicle must give way to the pedestrian.

(5)If a driver at a T‑intersection is turning from the continuing road into the terminating road using a slip lane, the driver must give way to —

(a)any vehicle approaching from the right (except a vehicle making a U turn on the terminating road at the intersection); and

(b)any pedestrian on the slip lane.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(6)If a driver at a T‑intersection is turning right from the continuing road into the terminating road, the driver must give way to —

(a)any oncoming vehicle that is travelling through the intersection on the continuing road or turning left at the intersection; and

(b)any pedestrian who is crossing the terminating road at or near the intersection.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(7)In this regulation —

turning left from the continuing road into the terminating road, for a driver, includes, where the continuing road curves to the right at a T‑intersection, leaving the continuing road to proceed straight ahead onto the terminating road;

turning right from the continuing road into the terminating road, for a driver, includes, where the continuing road curves to the left at a T‑intersection, leaving the continuing road to proceed straight ahead onto the terminating road.

Examples

Example 4

Driver turning right from the continuing road giving way to an oncoming vehicle travelling through the intersection on the
continuing road

Example 5

Driver turning right from the continuing road giving way to an oncoming vehicle travelling through the intersection on the
continuing road

Example 5 shows a T‑intersection where the continuing road (which is marked with broken white lines) goes around a corner. Vehicle B is leaving the continuing road to enter the terminating road. In examples 4 and 5, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

Example 6

Driver turning right from the continuing road giving way to an oncoming vehicle turning left from the continuing road

Example 7

Driver turning right from the continuing road giving way to a pedestrian on the terminating road

In example 6, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

In example 7, the vehicle must give way to the pedestrian.

[Regulation 56 amended: Gazette 8 Feb 2008 p. 317; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4575‑6; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5751; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 3Entering or leaving land abutting a carriageway or road

57.Giving way when entering carriageway from land abutting carriageway or road

(1)A driver entering a carriageway from land abutting the carriageway, without a traffic‑control signal or a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign or give way line, must give way to —

(a)any vehicle travelling on the carriageway or turning into the carriageway (except a vehicle turning right into the carriageway from land abutting the carriageway); and

(b)any pedestrian on the carriageway; and

(c)any vehicle or pedestrian on any land abutting the carriageway (including a path) that the driver crosses to enter the carriageway.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Example

Driver entering a carriageway from land abutting the carriageway giving way to a pedestrian on the footpath and a vehicle on the carriageway

In this example, vehicle B must give way to the pedestrian on the footpath and to vehicle A.

[(2)omitted under the Reprints Act 1984 s. 7(4)(e)]

[Regulation 57 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

58.Giving way when entering land abutting carriageway or road from carriageway

A driver entering land abutting a carriageway or road from a place on a carriageway without a traffic‑control signal or a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign or give way line, must give way to —

(a)any pedestrian on the carriageway; and

(b)any vehicle or pedestrian on any land abutting the carriageway that the driver crosses or enters; and

(c)if the driver is turning right from the carriageway — any oncoming vehicle on the carriageway that is going straight ahead or turning left; and

(d)if the carriageway the driver is leaving ends at a T‑intersection opposite the land abutting the carriageway and the driver is crossing the continuing road — any vehicle on the continuing road.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Examples

Example 1

Driver turning right from a carriageway into land abutting a carriageway giving way to an oncoming vehicle that is going straight ahead and to a pedestrian on the footpath

Example 2

Driver crossing a continuing road at a T‑intersection to enter land abutting a carriageway giving way to a vehicle on the continuing road

In each example, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A. In example 1, vehicle B must also give way to the pedestrian on the footpath.

[Regulation 58 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 4Keeping clear of and giving way to particular vehicles

59.Giving way to public buses

(1)A driver driving on a length of carriageway in a built‑up area, in the left lane or left line of traffic, must give way to a public bus in front of the driver if —

(a)the public bus has stopped, or is moving slowly at the far left side of the carriageway, or in a bus embayment; and

(b)the right indicator lights of the public bus are operating; and

(c)the public bus is about to enter or proceed in the lane or line of traffic in which the driver is driving; and

(d)the public bus is displaying a “give way to buses” sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)In this regulation —

left lane, of a carriageway, means —

(a)the marked lane nearest to the far left side of the carriageway (the first lane) or, if the first lane is a bicycle lane, the marked lane next to the first lane; or

(b)if there is an obstruction in the first lane (for example, a parked car or roadworks) and the first lane is not a bicycle lane — the marked lane next to the first lane;

left line of traffic, for a carriageway, means the line of traffic nearest to the far left side of the carriageway;

public bus includes buses of a type, class, or function approved by the CEO for the purposes of this regulation.

Give way to buses sign

(bus, arrow and edging in green, bus indicator

in yellow, words and car in red)

Note   This sign may be displayed on public buses.

[Regulation 59 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

60.Keeping clear of police and emergency vehicles

(1)A driver must give way to, and make every reasonable effort to give a clear and uninterrupted passage to, every police or emergency vehicle that is displaying a flashing blue or red light (whether or not it is also displaying other lights) or sounding an alarm.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 8 PU

(2)This regulation applies to a driver despite any other regulation that would otherwise require the driver of a police or emergency vehicle to give way to the driver.

[Regulation 60 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 5Crossings and shared zones

61.Children’s crossings

(1)A driver approaching a children’s crossing must drive at a speed at which the driver can, if necessary, stop safely before the crossing.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(2)A driver must stop the vehicle before it reaches a children’s crossing, if a “children crossing ‑ stop” sign is displayed to face approaching drivers; and must not permit any portion of the vehicle to enter upon the children’s crossing, while any pedestrian is on it or while the sign is displayed.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 6 PU

Children crossing — stop sign

(octagonal background in red)

(square background in lime/yellow)

(3)A driver must not enter upon, or attempt to cross, a children’s crossing if the carriageway beyond it is blocked.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Examples

The carriageway beyond the crossing may be blocked by congested traffic, a disabled vehicle, a collision between vehicles or between a vehicle and a pedestrian, or by a fallen load on the carriageway.

(4)Where there is a stop line on the approach side of a children’s crossing, any stop made under the provisions of this regulation, must be made before reaching, and as nearly as practicable to, the stop line.

(5)For the purposes of subregulation (2), if a children’s crossing extends across a road with a median strip, the part of the children’s crossing on each side of the median strip is taken to be a separate children’s crossing.

[Regulation 61 amended: Gazette 8 Feb 2008 p. 317; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3243 and 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

62.Pedestrian crossings

(1)A driver approaching a pedestrian crossing must drive at a speed at which the driver can, if necessary, stop safely before the crossing.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(2)A driver must give way to a pedestrian who is on a pedestrian crossing.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

Examples

Example 1

Giving way to a pedestrian on a pedestrian crossing

Example 2

Giving way to a pedestrian on a pedestrian crossing at a slip lane

In each of these examples, the driver must give way to the pedestrian on the crossing.

(3)A driver must stop the vehicle before it reaches a pedestrian crossing if a “children crossing – stop” sign is displayed to face approaching drivers, and must not permit any portion of the vehicle to enter upon the pedestrian crossing while any pedestrian is on it or while the sign is displayed.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 6 PU

Children crossing — stop sign

(octagonal background in red)

(square background in lime/yellow)

(4)A driver must not enter upon, or attempt to cross, a pedestrian crossing if the carriageway beyond it is blocked.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Examples

The carriageway beyond the crossing may be blocked by congested traffic, a disabled vehicle, a collision between vehicles or between a vehicle and a pedestrian, or by a fallen load on the carriageway.

(5)Despite subregulation (4), a driver may enter upon or attempt to cross a pedestrian crossing if —

(a)the pedestrian crossing is immediately before an intersection that is not controlled by traffic lights; and

(b)the pedestrian crossing is not blocked; and

(c)the driver gives way to any pedestrian on the pedestrian crossing at the time the driver enters upon or attempts to cross the pedestrian crossing.

(6)If entering a pedestrian crossing under subregulation (5), a driver may remain on that crossing until the intersection immediately after the crossing is safe to enter or cross.

[Regulation 62 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; 8 Feb 2008 p. 317; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6564; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3244 and 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

63.Overtaking or passing vehicle at children’s crossing or pedestrian crossing

A driver approaching a children’s crossing or a pedestrian crossing must not overtake or pass a vehicle that is travelling in the same direction as the driver and is stopping, or has stopped, to give way to a pedestrian at the crossing.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 8 PU

Example

Driver must not pass a vehicle that has stopped to
give way to a pedestrian at a pedestrian crossing

In the example, vehicle A has stopped to give way to a pedestrian on the crossing. Vehicle B must not overtake or pass vehicle A.

[Regulation 63 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

64.Giving way to pedestrians in shared zone

A driver in a shared zone must give way to any pedestrian in the zone.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 64 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 6Other give way requirements

65.Giving way when driving through break in median strip

If a driver drives through a break in a median strip that has no “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign or give way line, the driver must give way to any vehicle travelling on the part of the carriageway the driver is entering (except a vehicle to which a “stop” sign, stop line, “give way” sign, or give way line, applies).

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Examples

Example 1

Giving way when driving through a break in a median strip

Example 2

Giving way when driving through a break in a dividing strip to leave a service road

Example 3

Giving way when driving through a break in a dividing strip to enter a service road

In each of the examples, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

[Regulation 65 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

66.Giving way on painted island

A driver entering a turning lane from a painted island must give way to —

(a)any vehicle in the turning lane; or

(b)if the turning lane and painted island are nearest to the far left side of the road — any vehicle entering the turning lane from the marked lane, or line of traffic, immediately to the right of the turning lane; or

(c)if the turning lane and painted island are nearest to the dividing line or median strip on the road or the far right side of the road — any vehicle entering the turning lane from the marked lane, or line of traffic, immediately to the left of the turning lane.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Example 1

Driver entering a turning lane from a painted island giving way to a vehicle entering the turning lane from the marked lane immediately to the right of the turning lane

Example 2

Driver entering a turning lane from a painted island giving way to a vehicle entering the turning lane from the marked lane immediately to the left of the turning lane

test2 for dave

In the examples, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

[Regulation 66 inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4576‑8; amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3245; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

67.Giving way in median turning bay

A driver entering a median turning bay must give way to any oncoming vehicle already in the turning bay.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Example

Giving way in a median turning bay

In the example, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

Median turning lane sign

Note   There is another permitted version of the median turning lane sign.

[Regulation 67 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

68.Giving way when moving from boundary of carriageway, or parking area on or in median strip

(1)A driver entering a marked lane, or a line of traffic, from the boundary of a carriageway must give way to any vehicle travelling in the lane or line of traffic.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)Despite subregulation (1), the driver of a public bus does not have to give way to a vehicle if —

(a)the driver of the vehicle is required to give way to the public bus under regulation 59; and

(b)it is safe for the public bus to enter the lane or line of traffic in which the vehicle is driving.

(3)A driver turning from a median strip parking area into a marked lane, or a line of traffic, must give way to any vehicle travelling in the lane or line of traffic.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 68 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 8Traffic signs and road markings

Division 1Traffic signs and road markings at intersections and other places

[Heading amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4578

69.Left turn only signs

(1)Where a carriageway at an approach to an intersection has a “left turn only” sign by the side of it, or over it, a driver entering the intersection from that carriageway must only turn left.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)Where a marked lane at an approach to an intersection has a “left lane must turn left” sign by the side of, or over, the lane, a driver entering the intersection from that lane must only turn left.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Left turn only sign

Left lane must turn left sign

Note    There is another permitted version of each of these signs.

[Regulation 69 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

70.Right turn only signs

(1)Where a carriageway at an approach to an intersection has a “right turn only” sign by the side of it, or over it, a driver entering the intersection from that carriageway must only turn right.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)Where a marked lane at an approach to an intersection has a “right lane must turn right” sign by the side of, or over, the lane, a driver entering the intersection from that lane must only turn right.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)Where a driver is subject to either a “right turn only” sign, or a “right lane must turn right” sign, the driver must not make a U turn.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Right turn only sign

Right lane must turn right sign

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of the “right turn only” sign, and another permitted version of the “right lane must turn right” sign.

[Regulation 70 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

71.No turns signs

If there is a “no turns” sign at an intersection, a driver must not turn left or right, or make a U turn, at the intersection.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

No turns sign

[Regulation 71 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

72.No left turn and no right turn signs

(1)If there is a “no left turn” sign at an intersection, or another place on a road, a driver must not turn left at the intersection or place.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)If there is a “no right turn” sign at an intersection, or another place on a road, a driver must not turn right and, unless there is a “U turn permitted” sign, must not make a U turn at the intersection or place.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

No left turn signs

No left turn sign
(Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

No left turn sign
(Variable illuminated message sign)

(circle and slash illuminated in red)

No right turn signs

No right turn sign
(Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

No right turn sign
(Variable illuminated message sign)

(circle and slash illuminated in red)

No right turn sign

(letters illuminated in white)

Note   There is another permitted version of each of the “no left turn” signs and a number of other permitted versions of the “no right turn” signs.

U turn permitted sign

[Regulation 72 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4579; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

73.Traffic lane arrows

(1)Subject to subregulation (2), if a driver is driving in a marked lane at an intersection and there are traffic lane arrows applying to the lane, the driver must —

(a)if the arrows indicate a single direction — drive in that direction; or

(b)if the arrows indicate 2 or more directions — drive in one of those directions.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply to a driver if —

(a)the intersection is a roundabout; or

(b)traffic lane arrows indicate a direction to the right (whether or not they also indicate another direction) and the driver is making a U turn at the intersection; or

(c)a traffic sign indicates that a driver of a particular type of vehicle, or in stated circumstances, may drive in a direction different to that indicated by the traffic lane arrows; or

(d)the driver is driving in the direction indicated by traffic lane arrows that apply to one or more marked lanes and there is an obstruction in each of those lanes; or

(e)the driver is turning at an intersection in accordance with regulation 21(2) or 26(2).

Examples

Example 1

Traffic lane arrows on the surface of marked lanes

Example 2

Traffic lane arrows on a traffic sign

(3)The existence of a bicycle storage area in a marked lane does not alter a driver’s obligation to comply with subregulation (1).

[Regulation 73 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4579‑80; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 2Traffic signs and road markings generally

74.No overtaking or passing signs

(1)Where a “no overtaking or passing” sign is erected to face an approaching driver, the driver must not —

(a)pass the sign while any vehicle travelling in the opposite direction is on the length of carriageway to which the sign applies; or

(b)while on the length of carriageway to which the sign applies, overtake or pass a vehicle travelling in the same direction.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)A “no overtaking or passing” sign on a carriageway applies to the length of carriageway (including a length of carriageway on a bridge) beginning at the sign and ending —

(a)if information on or with the sign indicates a distance — at that distance past the sign; or

(b)if the sign applies to a bridge — at the end of the bridge; or

(c)at an “end no overtaking or passing” sign on the carriageway.

No overtaking or passing sign

End no overtaking or passing sign

[Regulation 74 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

75.No overtaking on bridge sign

Where a “no overtaking on bridge” sign is erected near a bridge to face an approaching driver, then the driver must not overtake a vehicle, while between the sign and the far end of the bridge.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

No overtaking on bridge sign

Note   There is another permitted version of this sign.

[Regulation 75 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

76.Emergency stopping lane only signs

The driver of a vehicle (other than a bicycle) must not drive in a lane to which an “emergency stopping lane only” sign applies unless the driver needs to drive in the emergency stopping lane to avoid a collision, to stop in the lane in accordance with regulation 150, or because the driver’s vehicle is disabled.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 6 PU

Emergency stopping lane only sign

[Regulation 76 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

76A.Emergency stopping bay signs

The driver of a vehicle (other than a bicycle) must not drive in an emergency stopping bay unless —

(a)the driver needs to drive in the bay to avoid a collision; or

(b)the driver needs to stop in the bay in accordance with regulation 150; or

(c)the driver’s vehicle is disabled.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 6 PU

Emergency stopping bay signs

(background to “emergency” in red)

(background to phone in blue)

Emergency Stopping Bay Only

[Regulation 76A inserted: SL 2020/184 r. 10.]

77.Keep clear markings

A driver must not stop on an area of a carriageway marked with a keep clear marking.

Modified penalty: 4 PU

Examples

Example 1

Keep clear marking bounded by line road markings

Example 2

Keep clear marking with no line road markings

[Regulation 77 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

78.Road access signs

(1)A person must not drive on a length of road to which a “road access” sign applies if information on or with the sign indicates that the person or the person’s vehicle is not permitted beyond the sign.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)A “road access” sign applies to the length of road beginning at the sign (including any road into which the length of road merges) and ending —

(a)if the sign is on a freeway or on a road leading to a freeway — at an “end freeway” sign or “end road access” sign on the road; or

(b)if the sign is on any other road — at the nearer of the following:

(i)if the road ends at a T‑intersection or dead end — the end of the road;

(ii)an “end road access” sign on the road.

Road access sign

End freeway sign

(background in green)

End road access sign

Note 1   There are a number of other permitted versions of the “road access” sign and the “end freeway” sign.

Note 2   A “road access” sign may indicate that it applies to different or additional vehicles or persons.

[Regulation 78 amended: Gazette 13 Jul 2001 p. 3473; 23 Sep 2003 p. 4167; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4580‑1; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3244; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

79.Further restrictions on freeways

(1)In addition to regulation 78, a person must not on any portion of a freeway —

(a)drive a tractor, other than the prime mover type, unless the vehicle is used by an authorised body for maintenance and construction work on that road; or

(b)drive or ride a moped or an animal; or

(c)ride a bicycle, except on a path; or

(d)walk, other than on a footpath, separated footpath or shared path (except in the event of an emergency or breakdown, or to assist a person apparently in need of assistance); or

(e)drive a vehicle with an oversized load unless permitted to do so under a road law.

Modified penalty: 6 PU

(2)In subregulation (1) —

moped means a motor cycle that has a propelling engine having a piston displacement not exceeding 50 mL and that is designed so as not to be capable of a speed exceeding 50 km/h, whether or not it is also capable of being propelled as a pedal cycle, but does not include a power assisted pedal cycle.

[Regulation 79 amended: Gazette 13 Jul 2001 p. 3473; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4581‑2; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4920; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

80.One‑way signs

(1)A driver must not drive on a carriageway to which a “one‑way” sign applies, except in the direction indicated by the arrow on the sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(2)A “one‑way” sign applies to the length of carriageway beginning at the sign and ending at the nearer of the following —

(a)a “two‑way” sign on the carriageway; or

(b)a “keep left” sign on the carriageway; or

(c)another sign or road marking on the carriageway that indicates that the carriageway is a two‑way carriageway; or

(d)if the carriageway ends at a T‑intersection — the end of the carriageway.

One‑way sign

Two‑way sign

Keep left sign

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of the “one‑way” sign and another permitted version of the “two‑way” sign.

Note   A “one‑way” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction.

[Regulation 80 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

81.Keep left and keep right signs

(1)Where a “keep left” sign is erected to face an approaching driver on a carriageway, the driver must pass to the left of that sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)Where a “keep right” sign is erected to face an approaching driver on a carriageway, the driver must pass to the right of that sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Keep left sign

Keep right sign

Note   There is another permitted version of the “keep right” sign.

[Regulation 81 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 16.]

82.No entry signs

Where a “no entry” sign is erected over or adjacent to a carriageway, to face an approaching driver, the driver must not proceed on that carriageway beyond the sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

No entry sign

(circular background in red)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of this sign.

[Regulation 82 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

83.Hand‑held stop signs

(1)A driver approaching a hand‑held “stop” sign must stop before reaching the sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(2)A driver who has stopped at a hand held “stop” sign must not proceed until the holder of the sign —

(a)no longer displays the sign towards the driver; or

(b)otherwise indicates that the driver may proceed.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)This regulation does not apply to a driver approaching or at a hand‑held “stop” sign if the circumstances are dealt with under Part 7 Division 5 (i.e. children’s or pedestrian crossings).

Hand‑held stop signs

(background in red)(background in orange)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of this sign.

[Regulation 83 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 3Signs for trucks, buses and other large vehicles

84.Clearance and low clearance signs

The driver of a vehicle must not drive past a “clearance” sign, or a “low clearance” sign, if the driver’s vehicle, any vehicle connected to it or any load carried by the vehicle, is higher than the height (in metres) indicated by the sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Clearance sign

Low clearance sign

[Regulation 84 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

85.Load limit signs

(1)A driver must not drive past a “bridge load limit (gross mass)” sign, or “gross load limit” sign, if the total mass (in tonnes) of the driver’s vehicle and any load, together with any vehicle connected to it and any load, is more than the gross mass indicated by the sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)A driver must not drive past a “bridge load limit (mass per axle group)” sign if the mass (in tonnes) carried by an axle group of the driver’s vehicle and its load, or the mass of an axle group of any vehicle connected to it and its load, is more than the mass indicated by the sign for the axle group.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Bridge load limit (gross mass) sign

Gross load limit sign

Bridge load limit (mass per axle group) sign

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of the bridge load limit (mass per axle group) sign.

[Regulation 85 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

86.No trucks signs

(1)The driver of a truck must not drive past a “no trucks” sign that has information on or with it indicating a mass, if the GVM of that truck (or, if the driver is driving a combination, any vehicle in the combination) is more than that mass.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)The driver of a truck must not drive past a “no trucks” sign that has information on or with it indicating a length, if the length of that truck (or, if the driver is driving a combination, the length of the combination) is longer than that length.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)The driver of a truck must not drive past a “no trucks” sign that has no information on or with it indicating a mass or length.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

No trucks sign

(circle and slash in red)

(4)It is a defence to a prosecution for an offence against subregulation (1), (2) or (3) if the driver satisfies the court that his or her destination lay beyond a “no trucks” sign and —

(a)there was no other route by which the driver’s truck could reach that destination; or

(b)any other route by which the driver’s truck could have reached that destination would require the truck to pass another “no trucks” sign.

[Regulation 86 amended: Gazette 2 Oct 2007 p. 4975‑6; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

87.Trucks must enter signs

If the driver of a truck drives past a “trucks must enter” sign, the driver must enter the area indicated by information on or with the sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Trucks must enter sign

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of this sign.

[Regulation 87 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

88.No buses signs

(1)The driver of a bus must not drive past a “no buses” sign that has information on or with it indicating a mass if the GVM of the bus is more than that mass.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)The driver of a bus must not drive past a “no buses” sign that has information on or with it indicating a length if the bus is longer than that length.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)The driver of a bus must not drive past a “no buses” sign that has no information on or with it indicating a mass or length.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

No buses sign

(circle and slash in red)

[Regulation 88 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

89.Buses must enter signs

If the driver of a bus drives past a “buses must enter” sign, the driver must enter the area indicated by information on or with the sign.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Buses must enter sign

Note   There is another permitted version of this sign.

[Regulation 89 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

90.Trucks and buses low gear signs

(1)If the driver of a truck or a bus is driving on a length of carriageway to which a “trucks and buses low gear” sign applies, the driver must drive the truck or bus in a gear that is low enough to limit the speed of the truck or the bus without the use of a primary brake.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)A “trucks and buses low gear” sign on a carriageway applies to the length of carriageway beginning at the sign and ending —

(a)if information on or with the sign indicates a distance — at that distance on the carriageway from the sign; or

(b)in any other case — at an “end trucks and buses low gear” sign on the carriageway.

(3)In this regulation —

“end trucks and buses low gear” sign includes a sign that simply states “end truck low gear”;

primary brake means the footbrake, or other brake, fitted to a truck that is normally used to slow or stop the vehicle;

“trucks and buses low gear” sign includes a sign that simply states that “trucks must use low gear”.

Trucks and buses low gear sign

End trucks and buses low gear sign

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of these signs.

[Regulation 90 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

91A.Safety ramp and arrester bed signs

(1)In this regulation —

arrester bed means an area to which an “arrester bed” sign applies;

safety ramp means an area to which a “safety ramp” sign applies.

(2)A driver must not drive on a safety ramp or arrester bed, unless —

(a)it is necessary for the driver to drive on the safety ramp or arrester bed in the interests of safety; or

(b)the driver is permitted to drive on the safety ramp or arrester bed under another written law of the State.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

Arrester bed sign

Safety bed sign

Note   There are other permitted versions of these signs.

[Regulation 91A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4582; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 9 Roundabouts

91.Terms used

(1)In this Part —

left turn signal means a signal of intention to turn left (including to diverge left) as prescribed in Part 5;

right turn signal means a signal of intention to turn right (including to diverge right) as prescribed in Part 5;

roundabout means an intersection —

(a)with one or more marked lanes, all of which are for the use of vehicles travelling in the same direction around a central traffic island; or

(b)with room for one or more lines of traffic travelling in the same direction around a central traffic island,

whether or not there is a “roundabout” sign at each entrance.

Roundabout sign

(triangle in red)

(2)A driver leaves a roundabout halfway around the roundabout if the driver leaves the roundabout on a carriageway that is straight ahead, or substantially straight ahead, of the carriageway on which the driver enters the roundabout.

[Regulation 91 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4583.]

92.Entering multi‑lane roundabout

(1)A driver entering a roundabout from a multi‑lane carriageway, or a carriageway with 2 or more lines of traffic travelling in the same direction as the driver, must enter the roundabout in accordance —

(a)with regulation 97; and

(b)with this regulation (if it is consistent with regulation 97).

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)If a driver is to leave a multi‑lane roundabout less than halfway around it, the driver must enter the roundabout from the left marked lane or left line of traffic.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Example 1

Leaving a roundabout less than halfway around it

(3)If a driver is to leave a multi‑lane roundabout more than halfway around it, the driver must enter the roundabout from the right marked lane or right line of traffic.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Example 2

Leaving a roundabout more than halfway around it

(4)If a driver is to leave a multi‑lane roundabout halfway around it, the driver may enter the roundabout from any marked lane or line of traffic.

Example

Example 3

Leaving a roundabout halfway around it

(5)Despite subregulations (2) to (4), if a driver is entering a roundabout from a marked lane and there are traffic lane arrows applying to the lane, the driver must —

(a)if the arrows indicate a single direction — drive in that direction after entering the roundabout; or

(b)if the arrows indicate 2 or more directions — drive in one of those directions after entering the roundabout.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(6)Subregulation (3) does not apply to a rider of a bicycle or an animal.

(7)Subregulation (5) does not apply to a rider of a bicycle or an animal if the rider is to leave the roundabout more than half way round it.

Examples

Example 4

Roundabout with 3 entry points

John_moore_drawings

Example 5

Roundabout with 5 entry points

[Regulation 92 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6753; 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4584‑5; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

93.Indicating left when entering roundabout

(1)This regulation applies to a driver entering a roundabout, if the driver is to leave the roundabout at the first exit after entering the roundabout and that exit is less than half way around the roundabout.

(2)A driver must —

(a)give a left turn signal when the driver is approaching the roundabout; and

(b)continue to give a left turn signal until the driver has left the roundabout.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 93 amended: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5751; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

94.Indicating right when entering roundabout

(1)This regulation applies to a driver entering a roundabout, if the driver is to leave the roundabout more than halfway around it.

(2)A driver must —

(a)give a right turn signal when the driver is approaching the roundabout; and

(b)continue to give the right turn signal while the driver is driving in the roundabout, unless the driver is changing marked lanes, entering another line of traffic or required by regulation 99 to give a left turn signal.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 94 amended: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5752; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

95.Right of way in roundabout

A driver entering a roundabout must give way to a vehicle that is within the roundabout.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

[Regulation 95 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

96.Driving through roundabout

(1)A driver driving in a roundabout must drive —

(a)to the left of the central traffic island in the roundabout; or

(b)if subregulation (2) applies to the driver — on the edge of the central island, to the left of the centre of the island; or

(c)if subregulation (3) applies to the driver — over the central island, to the left of the centre of the island.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

(2)This subregulation applies to a driver if —

(a)the driver’s vehicle is too large to drive in the roundabout without driving on the edge of the central traffic island; and

(b)the driver can safely drive on the edge of the central traffic island.

(3)This subregulation applies to a driver if —

(a)the driver’s vehicle is too large to drive in the roundabout without driving over the central traffic island; and

(b)the central traffic island is designed to allow a vehicle of that kind to be driven over it.

[Regulation 96 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4585; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

97.Obeying marked arrows when driving in or leaving roundabout

If a driver is driving in a marked lane in a roundabout and there are arrows marked on the surface of the road applying to the lane, the driver must —

(a)if the arrows indicate a single direction — drive in or leave the roundabout in that direction; or

(b)if the arrows indicate 2 or more directions — drive in or leave the roundabout in one of those directions.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 97 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

98.Indicating when changing lanes or lines of traffic in roundabout

(1)A driver driving in a roundabout must give a left turn signal before the driver changes lanes to the left, or enters a line of traffic to the left, in the roundabout.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A driver driving in a roundabout must give a right turn signal before the driver changes lanes to the right, or enters a line of traffic to the right, in the roundabout.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 98 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

99.Indicating left when leaving roundabout

A driver driving in a roundabout must, if practicable, give a left turn signal when leaving the roundabout.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 99 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

100.Rider of bicycle or animal to give way to vehicle leaving roundabout

The rider of a bicycle or an animal who is riding in the far left marked lane of a roundabout with 2 or more marked lanes, or the far left line of traffic in a roundabout with 2 or more lines of traffic, must give way to any vehicle leaving the roundabout.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 100 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 10 Level crossings

101.Stopping at level crossing

(1)A driver approaching a level crossing with a “stop” sign must stop the vehicle —

(a)as near as practicable to, but before reaching the stop line or, if there is no stop line, as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the “stop” sign; and

(b)give way to any train on, approaching or entering the crossing.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Stop sign

(background in red)

(2)If a driver approaching a level crossing is directed or instructed to stop by a railway employee, the driver must stop the vehicle, and the driver must not proceed except in accordance with the railway employee’s direction.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 101 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4586; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

102.Approaching trains

(1)A driver must not enter a level crossing if an approaching train is visible or emits an audible signal and there is danger of collision between the driver’s vehicle and the train, and the driver must not proceed until he or she has ascertained that in the circumstances it is safe to do so.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)A driver must not enter a level crossing where twin alternating red lights are flashing or a warning bell is ringing at or near the level crossing, and the driver must not proceed until the lights or bell have ceased to flash or ring unless otherwise directed or instructed by a railway employee.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 102 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

103.Giving way at level crossing

A driver approaching, or at, a level crossing with a “give way” sign must give way to any train on, approaching or entering the crossing.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 4 PU

Give way sign

(triangle in red)

[Regulation 103 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

104.What to do if traffic is congested

A driver approaching a level crossing must not enter the level crossing where, by reason of traffic congestion, he or she is not immediately able to lawfully drive the vehicle over and clear of the level crossing, and must not proceed until he or she can so drive the vehicle over and clear of the level crossing.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 104 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

105.Leaving level crossing

A driver who enters a level crossing must leave the level crossing as soon as he or she can do so safely.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 105 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

106.Stopping at level crossing when vehicle is carrying dangerous goods

The driver of a vehicle that is carrying any explosive, inflammable, corrosive or poisonous gas, liquid or material of any kind (other than fuel in the fuel tank of the vehicle) must stop the vehicle before passing over a level crossing that is not equipped with twin alternating red lights or gates, booms or other barriers for closing the crossing to road traffic and must not proceed until the driver has ascertained that he or she may do so without danger of conflict with a train.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 106 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

107.Driving around boom gates

A person must not drive a vehicle through, around or under any gate, boom or barrier at a level crossing or enter upon the crossing while the gate, boom or barrier is closed or is being opened or closed to road traffic.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 107 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 11Keeping left, overtaking and other driving provisions

Division 1General

108.Obstruction of vehicles and pedestrians

(1)A person must not, with intent to hinder or obstruct the passage of any vehicle or vehicles on a carriageway, park or stop a vehicle on the carriageway in such a manner as to cause the passage of any other vehicle on the carriageway to be obstructed or hindered.

(2)A driver must not unreasonably obstruct the path of another driver or a pedestrian.

(3)In subregulation (2), a driver does not unreasonably obstruct the path of another driver or a pedestrian only because —

(a)the driver is stopped in traffic; or

(b)the driver is driving more slowly than other vehicles (unless the driver is driving abnormally slowly in the circumstances).

Example of a driver driving abnormally slowly

A driver driving at a speed of 20 km/h on a length of carriageway to which a speed‑limit of 80 km/h applies when there is no reason for the driver to drive at that speed on the length of carriageway.

[Regulation 108 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

109.Keeping safe distance behind vehicles

Except when overtaking and passing, the driver of any vehicle must, when following another vehicle, keep such distance behind it as will enable the driver to stop the vehicle in an emergency with safety, and without running into the vehicle in front of him or her.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 109 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3246 and 3247; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

110.Keeping minimum distance between long vehicles

(1)In this regulation —

B‑double has the meaning given in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 3;

long vehicle means a vehicle or combination 7.5 m or more in length, inclusive of any projection and of its load, other than a B‑double or a road train;

road train has the meaning given in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 3.

(2)The driver of a long vehicle (the vehicle) when following another long vehicle, a B‑double or a road train outside a built‑up area must, wherever conditions permit, keep the vehicle not less than 60 m behind the other vehicle unless the vehicle is —

(a)on a carriageway with 2 or more marked lanes available exclusively for vehicles travelling in the same direction as that in which the vehicle is travelling; or

(b)overtaking or passing.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(3)The driver of a B‑double or a road train (the vehicle) when following a long vehicle, a B‑double or a road train outside a built‑up area must, wherever conditions permit, keep the vehicle not less than 200 m behind the other vehicle unless the vehicle is —

(a)on a carriageway with 2 or more marked lanes available exclusively for vehicles travelling in the same direction as that in which the B‑double or road train is travelling; or

(b)overtaking or passing.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 110 inserted: Gazette 31 Dec 2013 p. 6564-5; amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4921; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

111.No entry to choked intersection

(1)A driver must not enter upon, or attempt to cross, an intersection, whether or not it is controlled by a traffic‑control signal, if the intersection or the carriageway beyond it is blocked.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

Examples

The intersection, or a carriageway beyond the intersection, may be blocked by congested traffic, a disabled vehicle, a collision between vehicles or between a vehicle and a pedestrian, or by a fallen load on the carriageway.

(2)The provisions of subregulation (1) apply —

(a)despite the instruction of a traffic‑control signal to proceed; and

(b)in addition to the provisions of regulations 61(3), 62(4) and 145(2).

[Regulation 111 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 2Keeping to the left

112.Keeping as far left as practicable

(1)Except where these regulations provide otherwise, a driver must keep the vehicle as close as practicable to the left boundary of the carriageway, except where 2 or more lanes marked on the carriageway are available exclusively for vehicles travelling in the same direction.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply if the vehicle is a motor cycle.

[Regulation 112 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

113.Restriction on use of right lane

(1)In this regulation —

marked lane does not include —

(a)a lane set aside exclusively for vehicles making a left or right turn; or

(b)a special purpose lane; or

(c)any other lane that is not for the use of general traffic on the carriageway; or

(d)a slow vehicle turn out lane;

right lane, in relation to 2 or more marked lanes that are available exclusively for vehicles travelling in the same direction, means the marked lane that is further or furthest to the right side of the carriageway;

slow vehicle turn out lane means a lane or a part of a lane to which a “slow vehicle turn out lane” sign applies.

Slow vehicle turn out sign

(2)This regulation applies to a driver driving on a carriageway that has 2 or more marked lanes available exclusively for vehicles travelling in the same direction where —

(a)the speed limit is 90 km/h or more (or, if the driver is in a speed zone that begins with a variable illuminated speed limit sign, the speed limit applicable to the zone when the driver enters the zone is 90 km/h or more); or

(b)a “keep left unless overtaking” sign applies to that part of the carriageway,

or both.

(3)A driver must not drive the vehicle in the right lane unless —

(a)the driver is turning right, or making a U turn from the centre of the road, and is giving a right turn signal; or

(b)the driver is overtaking; or

(c)a “left lane must turn left” sign or left traffic arrows apply to any other lane, and the driver is not turning left; or

(d)the driver is required to drive in the right lane under regulation 137; or

(e)the driver is avoiding an obstruction; or

(f)the traffic in each other lane travelling in the same direction is congested; or

(g)there are only 2 marked lanes and the left lane is a slow vehicle turn out lane.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 1 PU

Left lane must turn left sign

(4)A “keep left unless overtaking” sign applies to a length of carriageway beginning at the sign and ending at the nearest of the following:

(a)an “end keep left unless overtaking” sign;

(b)a road sign or road marking that indicates the carriageway is no longer a multi‑lane carriageway;

(c)if the carriageway ends at a T‑intersection or dead end — the end of the carriageway.

Keep left unless overtaking sign

End keep left unless overtaking sign

(5)The CEO, by notice published in the Gazette —

(a)may declare that this regulation does not apply to the driving of a vehicle on a carriageway described in the notice; and

(b)may vary or revoke a previous notice under this subregulation.

[Regulation 113 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4586‑8; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928; SL 2020/184 r. 11; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

114.Keeping to left of oncoming vehicles

A driver of a vehicle on a carriageway passing a vehicle travelling in the opposite direction must keep to the left of that vehicle unless —

(a)the driver is turning right at an intersection; and

(b)the driver is passing an oncoming vehicle turning right at the intersection; and

(c)there is no road sign or road marking indicating that the driver must pass to the left of the oncoming vehicle.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

Examples

Example 1

Driving to the left of an
oncoming vehicle

Example 2

Oncoming vehicles turning right passing to the right of each other

[Regulation 114 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4588; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

115.Keeping to left of marked or unmarked two‑way carriageway

(1)Except where these regulations otherwise provide, a driver on a two‑way carriageway without a dividing line or median strip must travel to the left of the carriageway, unless the driver can see ahead for a distance sufficient to enable him or her to do so with safety or without interfering with the progress of any oncoming vehicle.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

(2)Except where these regulations otherwise provide, a driver on a two‑way carriageway without a median strip must not permit any portion of the vehicle to travel on or over or to the right of the centre of the carriageway when —

(a)approaching a crest of a gradient; or

(b)approaching, or upon, a curve,

unless the driver can see ahead for a distance sufficient to enable him or her to do so with safety or without interfering with the progress of any oncoming vehicle.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

[Regulation 115 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

116.Keeping to left of continuous dividing lines

(1)Where a carriageway is marked with a dividing line comprising —

(a)2 continuous lines; or

(b)a continuous line on the left of a broken or dotted line; or

(c)a continuous line,

a driver must not permit any portion of the vehicle to travel on, over, or to the right of, the dividing line except for the purpose of making a right turn or a U turn, where permissible.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

Examples

Example 1

Driving to the left of a single continuous dividing line only

Example 2

Driving to the left of a single continuous dividing line to the left of a broken dividing line

Example 3

Driving to the left of 2 parallel continuous dividing lines

(2)Subregulation (1) is subject to regulations 120 and 124A(5).

[Regulation 116 amended: Gazette 31 Oct 2017 p. 5462; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

117.Keeping to left of median strip

Where a road is divided by a median strip, a driver must not drive upon the median strip, or the carriageway to the right of the median strip, unless the driver is —

(a)entering or driving in a median strip parking area; or

(b)required to drive to the right of the median strip by a “keep right” sign; or

(c)using a special purpose lane as permitted by information on the sign applicable to that lane.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

Keep right sign

[Regulation 117 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

118.Service roads

(1)A driver on a part of the road that is a service road (except a service road to which a “two‑way” sign applies) must drive in the same direction as a vehicle travelling on the carriageway used by the main body of moving vehicles in the marked lane or line of traffic closest to the service road.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)In this Part, a service road to which a “two‑way” sign applies is treated as if it were a separate two‑way carriageway.

Two‑way sign

Note for diagram   There is another permitted version of the “two‑way” sign.

[Regulation 118 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

119.Driving on or across median strip, painted island etc.

(1)A person must not drive a vehicle on a traffic island or median strip except at a place designed and constructed, or improved, for use by vehicular traffic.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A person must not drive a vehicle on or over a painted island unless —

(a)it is to enter or leave the carriageway; or

(b)it is to avoid an obstruction, in accordance with regulation 120(4); or

(c)it is to enter a turning lane that begins immediately after the painted island; or

(d)it is to comply with regulation 124A(1), in accordance with regulation 124A(5).

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)Despite subregulation (2), a driver must not drive on a painted island for more than 50 m.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)Subregulation (1) does not apply to a central traffic island in a roundabout.

Note   A driver must drive to the left of the central traffic island in a roundabout except in certain circumstances.

Example

In this example, it is unlawful for vehicle B to have commenced driving on the painted island unless B intends to enter or leave the carriageway, or enter a turning lane, immediately after the painted island. In any case, B cannot drive on the painted island for more than 50 m.

(5)Subregulation (2)(a) does not apply in the case of a painted island —

(a)that separates a carriageway that takes vehicles in one direction from another carriageway that takes vehicles in the same direction at a place where the carriageways merge; or

(b)that separates one part of a carriageway from other parts of the carriageway to create a slip lane.

Examples

Example 1

Example 2

In these examples, vehicle B is contravening subregulation (2)(a) because of subregulation (5)(a).

[Regulation 119 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4168; 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4588‑9; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6565; 31 Oct 2017 p. 5462-3; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

120.Avoiding obstructions on carriageway

(1)A driver on a two‑way carriageway without a dividing line or median strip may drive to the right of the carriageway or into the other carriageway to avoid an obstruction if —

(a)the driver has a clear view of any approaching traffic; and

(b)it is necessary and reasonable, in all the circumstances, for the driver to drive in that manner to avoid the obstruction; and

(c)the driver can do so safely.

(2)A driver on a two‑way carriageway with a dividing line may drive to the right of the dividing line to avoid an obstruction if —

(a)the driver has a clear view of any approaching traffic; and

(b)it is necessary and reasonable, in all the circumstances, for the driver to drive to the right of the dividing line to avoid the obstruction; and

(c)the driver can do so safely.

(3)In subregulation (2), if the dividing line is a single continuous dividing line to the left of a broken dividing line, a single continuous dividing line only or 2 parallel continuous dividing lines, the hazard in driving to the right of such a dividing line must be taken into account in deciding whether it is reasonable to drive to the right of the dividing line.

(4)A driver may drive on a dividing strip, or on or over a single continuous line, or 2 parallel continuous lines, or on or over a painted island, to avoid an obstruction if —

(a)the driver has a clear view of any approaching traffic; and

(b)it is necessary and reasonable to drive on the dividing strip or painted island to avoid the obstruction; and

(c)the driver can do so safely.

[Regulation 120 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4168.]

Division 3Overtaking

121.No overtaking unless safe to do so

When a driver overtakes a vehicle on a two‑way carriageway, he or she must not drive to the right of the centre of the carriageway, unless the right side of the carriageway is free of oncoming traffic sufficiently far ahead to permit the overtaking movement to be completed with safety.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 8 PU

[Regulation 121 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

122.Overtaking

(1)When overtaking a moving vehicle, a driver of a vehicle (other than a bicycle) must, except as provided in subregulations (2) and (3), pass to the right of that vehicle, at a safe distance.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)Where a carriageway is a one‑way carriageway, or has 2 or more marked lanes for vehicles travelling in the same direction, a driver may overtake and pass in another marked lane to the left of a vehicle, if conditions permit him or her to do so with safety.

(3)A driver overtaking a vehicle making, or apparently about to make, a right turn or U turn from the middle of the carriageway and giving a right change of direction signal, must pass to the left of it and of any vehicle that may be stationary behind it, but only if it is safe to do so.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)The rider of a bicycle must not ride past, or overtake, to the left of a vehicle that is making, or apparently about to make, a left turn, or is signalling a left turn.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 122 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4589‑90; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

123.Passing or overtaking vehicle displaying do not overtake turning vehicle sign

(1)A driver must not drive past, or overtake, to the left of a vehicle or combination displaying a “do not overtake turning vehicle” sign if that vehicle or combination is turning left or is giving a left turn signal, unless it is safe to do so.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2A)A driver must not drive past, or overtake, to the left of a vehicle or combination displaying a “do not overtake turning vehicle” sign in any circumstance other than the one referred to in subregulation (1) unless —

(a)the driver is driving on a carriageway that has 2 or more marked lanes available exclusively for vehicles travelling in the same direction, the driver overtakes the vehicle or combination in a marked lane to the left of the vehicle or combination, and it is safe to do so; or

(b)the vehicle is turning right or making a U turn from the centre of the road and giving a right turn signal, and it is safe to overtake to the left of the vehicle or combination; or

(c)the vehicle is stationary and it is safe to overtake to the left of the vehicle or combination.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A driver must not drive past, or overtake, to the right of a vehicle or combination displaying a “do not overtake turning vehicle” sign if that vehicle or combination is turning right, or making a U turn from the centre of the road, or is giving a right turn signal, unless it is safe to do so.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

Do not overtake turning vehicle signs

(background in yellow)(top right portion in red, remainder

of background in yellow)

 

[Regulation 123 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6754; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5752; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

124.Keeping safe distance when overtaking

A driver overtaking a vehicle —

(a)must pass the vehicle at a sufficient distance to avoid a collision with that vehicle or to avoid obstructing the path of that vehicle; and

(b)must not return to the marked lane or line of traffic where the vehicle is travelling until the driver is a sufficient distance past that vehicle to avoid a collision with that vehicle or to avoid obstructing the path of that vehicle.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 8 PU

[Regulation 124 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

124A.Keeping safe distance when passing bicycle

(1)A driver of a motor vehicle passing to the right of a bicycle that is travelling on a road in the same direction as the vehicle must pass the bicycle at a safe distance from the bicycle.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 8 PU

(2)A safe distance from the bicycle is —

(a)if the speed limit applicable to the length of road is not more than 60 km/h — a lateral distance of at least 1 m; or

(b)if the speed limit applicable to the length of road is more than 60 km/h — a lateral distance of at least 1.5 m.

(2A)For the purposes of subregulation (2), if the driver of the motor vehicle is in a speed zone that begins with a variable illuminated speed limit sign, a reference to the speed limit applicable to the length of road is a reference to the speed limit applicable to the speed zone when the driver enters the zone.

(3)For the purposes of subregulation (2), the lateral distance is measured between the following points —

(a)the furthest point to the left on the driver’s vehicle or any projection from the vehicle (whether or not attached to the vehicle);

(b)the furthest point to the right on the bicycle.

(4)For the purposes of subregulation (3)(b) —

(a)the following things are to be taken to be part of the bicycle —

(i)any bicycle trailer as defined in regulation 223(3) towed by the bicycle;

(ii)any basket or pannier bags attached to the bicycle or bicycle trailer;

(iii)the rider of the bicycle;

(iv)any passenger on the bicycle, in the bicycle trailer or on the bicycle trailer;

and

(b)a flag or stick (whether or not flexible) attached to and projecting sideways from the bicycle or any bicycle trailer is to be taken not to be part of the bicycle or bicycle trailer.

(5)A driver of a motor vehicle may, if it is necessary in order to comply with subregulation (1), do any of the following —

(a)if the driver is driving on a two‑way carriageway without a dividing line or median strip — drive to the right of the centre of the carriageway, provided that the driver has a clear view of any approaching traffic and can do so safely;

(b)if the driver is driving on a two‑way carriageway with a dividing line — drive to the right of the dividing line, provided that the driver has a clear view of any approaching traffic and can do so safely;

(c)drive on a dividing strip, or on or over a single continuous line or 2 parallel continuous lines, or on or over a painted island, provided that the driver has a clear view of any approaching traffic and can do so safely.

[Regulation 124A inserted: Gazette 31 Oct 2017 p. 5463-4; amended: SL 2020/184 r. 12.]

125.Courtesy when overtaking

(1)Except where overtaking on the left is permitted, a driver being overtaken must move to the left in favour of the overtaking vehicle, and must not increase the speed of the vehicle, until it has been completely passed by the overtaking vehicle.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)A driver must not drive a vehicle on a road in such a manner as to prevent another vehicle from overtaking and passing him or her.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 4 PU

[Regulation 125 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 4Driving in marked lanes or lines of traffic

126.Driving in single lane on carriageway

(1)A driver must drive the vehicle as nearly as practicable entirely within a single marked lane or in a single line of traffic and must not move laterally from any such lane or line of traffic until he or she can do so with safety.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(1A)Subregulation (1) does not apply if the driver is the rider of a motor cycle who is lane filtering in accordance with regulation 130B.

(2)A driver who is moving laterally from any single marked lane (whether or not the lane is ending) or line of traffic must give way to any vehicle travelling in the same direction as the driver in the marked lane or line of traffic into which the driver is moving.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example 1

Giving way when moving from one marked lane that is not ending to another marked lane

In this example, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

Example 2

Giving way when moving from one marked lane that is ending to another marked lane

In this example, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

Example 3

Giving way when moving laterally from one line of traffic to another line of traffic (when the lines are not merging)

In this example, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

[Regulation 126 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; 22 Aug 2017 p. 4503‑4; SL 2020/253 r. 17.]

127.Moving from one marked lane to another marked lane across continuous line separating lanes

(1)Where a portion of a road is divided longitudinally by single, continuous lines, into 2 or more lanes, a person must not drive a vehicle across any of those lines.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)The provisions of subregulation (1) do not apply to a driver intending to make a left turn or a right turn, if —

(a)the driver’s vehicle or combination, together with any load or projection, is 7.5 m long, or longer; and

(b)the rearmost part of the vehicle (or of the combination, if that is the case) displays a “do not overtake turning vehicle” sign; and

(c)any part of the vehicle is within 50 m of the nearest point of the intersection; and

(d)(where a driver intends to turn right) it is not practicable for the driver to turn right from within the right lane; and

(e)(where a driver intends to turn left) it is not practicable for the driver to turn left from within the left lane; and

(f)the driver can safely occupy the next marked lane and can safely turn at the intersection by occupying the next marked lane, or both lanes.

(3)The provisions of subregulation (1) do not apply to a driver on a multi‑lane carriageway with a continuous line separating the lanes if —

(a)the driver is avoiding an obstruction; or

(aa)the driver is driving a motor vehicle and is passing a bicycle in accordance with regulation 124A(5); or

(b)the driver is obeying a traffic‑control signal applying to the first marked lane; or

(ba)the driver is the rider of a motor cycle who is lane filtering in accordance with regulation 130B; or

(c)either of the marked lanes is a special purpose lane in which the driver is permitted to drive and the driver is moving to or from the special purpose lane.

[Regulation 127 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6754; 31 Oct 2017 p. 5464; SL 2020/253 r. 18.]

128.Giving way when lines of traffic merge into single line of traffic

A driver in a line of traffic, that is merging with one or more lines of traffic travelling in the same direction as the driver, must give way to a vehicle in another line of traffic if any part of the vehicle is ahead of the driver’s vehicle.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Giving way when lines of traffic merge into a single line of traffic

In this example, vehicle B must give way to vehicle A.

[Regulation 128 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

129.Driving on or across continuous white edge line

(1)A driver must not drive on or over a continuous white edge line on a carriageway unless subregulation (2) or (3) applies to the driver.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A driver may drive on or over a continuous white edge line on a carriageway if the driver is —

(a)overtaking a vehicle that is turning right, or making a U turn from the centre of the road, and is giving a right change of direction signal; or

(b)driving a slow‑moving vehicle, and it is necessary for the driver to drive on or over the edge line to allow the vehicle to be overtaken or passed by another vehicle; or

(c)driving a vehicle that is too wide, or too long, to drive on the carriageway without driving on or over the edge line; or

(d)permitted to drive on or over the edge line under another written law of the State; or

(e)avoiding an obstruction.

(3)A driver may drive on or over a continuous white edge line on a carriageway for up to 100 m if the driver is —

(a)turning at an intersection; or

(b)entering or leaving the carriageway; or

(c)entering a part of the road of one kind from a part of the road of another kind (for example, moving to or from a service road, a shoulder of the road, an emergency stopping bay or an emergency stopping lane); or

(d)stopping at the side of the road (including any shoulder of the road).

(4)Subregulation (1) does not apply to the rider of a bicycle or animal.

(5)For the purposes of this regulation, a driver drives over a continuous white edge line on a carriageway if —

(a)for a line on the far left side of the carriageway — the driver’s vehicle is wholly or partly to the left of the line; or

(b)for a line on the far right side of the carriageway — the driver’s vehicle is wholly or partly to the right of the line.

[Regulation 129 inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4590‑1; amended: SL 2020/184 r. 13.]

130.Riding 2‑wheeled vehicle alongside more than one other rider

(1)The rider of a motor cycle, moped, power‑assisted pedal cycle or bicycle must not ride on a carriageway that is not a multi‑laned carriageway alongside more than one other rider, unless the rider is overtaking the other riders.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)The rider of a motor cycle, moped, power‑assisted pedal cycle or bicycle must not ride in a marked lane on a carriageway alongside more than one other rider, unless the rider is overtaking the other riders or one of the riders is the rider of a motor cycle who is lane filtering in accordance with regulation 130B.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)The rider of a power‑assisted pedal cycle or bicycle must not ride on a path alongside another rider, unless the rider is overtaking the other rider.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)If the rider of a motor cycle, moped, power‑assisted pedal cycle or bicycle is riding on a carriageway that is not a multi‑lane carriageway alongside another rider, or in a marked lane alongside another rider in the marked lane, the rider must, unless one of the riders is the rider of a motor cycle who is lane filtering in accordance with regulation 130B, ride not over 1.5 m from the other rider.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(5)In this regulation —

moped means a motor cycle that has a propelling engine having a piston displacement not exceeding 50 mL and that is designed so as not to be capable of a speed exceeding 50 km/h, whether or not it is also capable of being propelled as a pedal cycle, but does not include a power assisted pedal cycle;

motor cycle does not include —

(a)a 2‑wheeled motor vehicle with a sidecar attached to it that is supported by a third wheel; or

(b)a motor vehicle with 3 wheels that is ridden in the same way as a motor vehicle with 2 wheels.

[Regulation 130 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4591; SL 2020/253 r. 19.]

130A.Rider of motor cycle not to ride next to other vehicles except in certain circumstances

(1)In this regulation —

2‑wheeled motor cycle means a motor cycle other than —

(a)a 2‑wheeled motor vehicle with a sidecar attached to it that is supported by a third wheel; or

(b)a motor vehicle with 3 wheels that is ridden in the same way as a motor vehicle with 2 wheels.

(2)The rider of a motor cycle must not, unless overtaking in accordance with these regulations, ride on a carriageway alongside another vehicle that is —

(a)travelling in the same direction as the motor cycle; but

(b)not travelling in a separate marked lane to the motor cycle.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)Subregulation (2) does not apply if the motor cycle is a 2‑wheeled motor cycle and either —

(a)the rider of the motor cycle is lane filtering in accordance with regulation 130B; or

(b)the other vehicle is a motor cycle or bicycle.

(4)Subregulation (2) does not apply if the motor cycle is a motor cycle other than a 2‑wheeled motor cycle and the other vehicle is a 2‑wheeled motor cycle or bicycle.

[Regulation 130A inserted: SL 2020/253 r. 20.]

130B.When rider of a motor cycle is lawfully lane filtering

(1)The rider of a motor cycle is lane filtering in accordance with this regulation along a length of carriageway if —

(a)the motor cycle is not —

(i)a 2‑wheeled motor vehicle with a sidecar attached to it that is supported by a third wheel; or

(ii)a motor vehicle with 3 wheels that is ridden in the same way as a motor vehicle with 2 wheels;

and

(b)the rider rides the motor cycle between 2 vehicles, each vehicle travelling in —

(i)the same direction as the motor cycle; and

(ii)separate but adjacent marked lanes or lines of traffic.

(2)However, the rider of a motor cycle is not lane filtering in accordance with this regulation along a length of carriageway if any of the following circumstances apply —

(a)the rider is approaching or riding on a children’s crossing, marked foot crossing or pedestrian crossing;

(b)the rider is riding at a speed of more than 30km/h;

(c)the rider is riding in a school zone or shared zone;

(d)the speed limit applicable to the area or zone that the rider is in is 40km/h or below (or, in the case of a speed zone that begins with a variable illuminated speed limit sign, the speed limit applicable to the zone when the rider enters the zone is 40km/h or below);

[(e)deleted]

(f)1 or both of the vehicles that the rider is riding between is a heavy vehicle;

(g)the vehicles that the rider is riding between are merging;

(h)a “no overtaking or passing” sign applies to the length of carriageway within the meaning of regulation 74(2);

(i)the rider would not be permitted to overtake under regulation 75;

(j)it is not safe to do so in the circumstances;

(k)the rider is riding under the authority of a learner’s permit as defined in the Road Traffic (Authorisation to Drive) Act 2008 section 3(1);

(l)the rider is riding in a roundabout;

(m)the rider is riding in or next to a special purpose lane.

(3)The rider of a motor cycle who is lane filtering in accordance with this regulation is not overtaking for the purposes of these regulations.

[Regulation 130B inserted: SL 2020/253 r. 20 (as amended: SL 2021/30 r. 4).]

Division 5Obeying overhead traffic‑control signals applying to marked lanes

131.Overhead traffic‑control signals

(1)The driver of a vehicle must not drive in a red X lane unless —

(a)the driver of the vehicle would not be prohibited under these regulations from driving in the lane if the lane were an emergency stopping lane; or

(b)each of the following apply —

(i)driving in the red X lane is necessary for the driver to exit a freeway;

(ii)the driver drives in the red X lane for less than 100 m (or, where there are successive red X lanes, the total distance driven in the red X lanes is less than 100 m);

(iii)in the circumstances it is safe to drive in the red X lane.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply to a driver in relation to a red X lane if, at the time the driver entered the red X lane by driving past the traffic‑control signal over the lane at the beginning of the lane, the traffic‑control signal was not displaying an illuminated red diagonal cross.

(3)If the driver of a vehicle is in an overhead controlled lane and the traffic‑control signal over the lane displays an illuminated diagonal arrow signal, the driver may continue in the lane past the signal but must —

(a)leave the lane in the direction indicated by the arrow as soon as it is safe to do so; and

(b)move to a lane that does not have a traffic‑control signal over the lane displaying an illuminated diagonal arrow signal or an illuminated red diagonal cross.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 4 PU

Illuminated diagonal arrow signals

(4)If the driver of a vehicle is in an overhead controlled lane and the traffic‑control signal over the lane displays an illuminated white, green or yellow arrow pointing downwards, the driver may drive in the lane past the signal.

Examples

Overhead controlled lanes

(cross illuminated in red)

Overhead controlled lanes

(cross and circle illuminated in red)

[Regulation 131 inserted: SL 2020/184 r. 14.]

Division 6Driving in marked lanes designated for special purposes

132.Bicycle lanes

(1)The driver of a vehicle, other than a bicycle, must not drive in a bicycle lane, unless the driver is permitted to do so under this regulation or regulation 136.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)If stopping or parking is permitted at a place in a bicycle lane, the driver of a vehicle other than a bicycle may drive for up to 50 m in the bicycle lane to stop or park at that place.

(3)The driver of a public bus, or a taxi, may drive in a bicycle lane for up to 50 m if the driver is dropping off, or picking up, passengers.

Bicycle lane sign

End bicycle lane sign

[Regulation 132 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

133.Bus lanes

A person must not drive a vehicle along or into a bus lane unless —

(a)the vehicle is a public bus, an emergency vehicle or a special purpose vehicle; or

(b)the driver is permitted to do so under regulation 136.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

Bus lane sign

End bus lane sign

[Regulation 133 amended: Gazette 11 Jan 2002 p. 51; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

133A.Busways

(1)A person must not drive a vehicle along or into a busway unless —

(a)the vehicle is a public bus, an emergency vehicle or a special purpose vehicle; or

(b)a taxi, and there is a sign at the beginning of the busway indicating that taxis may enter that busway.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

Busway sign

End busway sign

Busway cropped

Busway and end cropped

(2)The driver of a vehicle in a busway must use the vehicle’s headlights at all times while driving in a busway.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)The driver of a vehicle in a busway must maintain a minimum distance of 250 m from any vehicle travelling in front of it.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)Subject to subregulation (6), a person must not alight from, or board, a vehicle in a busway.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(5)Subject to subregulation (6), the driver of a vehicle in a busway must not direct a person to alight from, or board, the vehicle.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(6)Subregulations (4) and (5) do not apply if it is necessary for a person to alight from, or board, a vehicle in a busway because —

(a)the vehicle is disabled; or

(b)there is a medical or other emergency.

[Regulation 133A inserted: Gazette 11 Jan 2002 p. 51; amended: Gazette 8 Feb 2008 p. 317-18; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

134.Transit lanes

A driver must not drive in a transit lane unless —

(a)the driver is driving —

(i)a public bus, motor cycle, or taxi; or

(ii)if the transit lane sign applying to the transit lane is a “transit lane (T2)” sign — a vehicle carrying at least one other person; or

(iii)if the transit lane sign applying to the transit lane is a “transit lane (T3)” sign — a vehicle carrying at least 2 other people;

or

(b)the driver is permitted to drive in the transit lane under regulation 136.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

Transit lane signs

Transit lane (T2) sign

(background to T2 in red)

Transit lane (T3) sign

(background to T3 in red)

 

End transit lane sign
(End transit lane (T2) sign)

(background to “T2” in red)

End transit lane sign
(End transit lane (T3) sign)

(background to “T3” in red)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of the “transit lane” signs.

[Regulation 134 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

135.Truck lanes

The driver of a vehicle other than a truck must not drive in a lane to which a “truck lane” sign applies, unless the driver is permitted to drive in the truck lane under regulation 136.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

Truck lane sign

End truck lane sign

[Regulation 135 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

136.Exceptions to driving in special purpose lanes etc.

(1)The driver of any vehicle may drive for up to the permitted distance in a bicycle lane, bus lane, transit lane or truck lane if it is necessary for the driver to drive in the lane —

(a)to enter or leave the carriageway; or

(b)to enter a part of the carriageway of one kind from a part of the carriageway of another kind (for example, moving to or from a service road, an emergency stopping bay or an emergency stopping lane); or

(c)to overtake a vehicle that is turning right, or making a
U turn from the centre of the road, and is giving a right turn signal; or

(d)to enter a marked lane, or a line of traffic, from the side of the carriageway.

(2)The driver of any vehicle may drive in a bicycle lane, bus lane, transit lane or truck lane if —

(a)it is necessary for the driver to drive in the lane to avoid an obstruction; or

(b)information on or with a traffic sign applying to the lane indicates that the driver may drive in the lane.

(3)It is a defence to the prosecution of a driver for an offence against a provision of this Division for driving in a bus lane, transit lane or truck lane if —

(a)it is necessary for the driver to drive in the lane to stop at a place in the lane; and

(b)it is a defence under regulation 138 for the driver to stop at that place.

(4)It is a defence to the prosecution of a driver for an offence against a provision of this Division for driving in a bicycle lane if —

(a)it is necessary for the driver to drive in the lane to stop at a place in the lane; and

(b)it is a defence under regulation 138 for the driver to stop at that place; and

(c)the driver drives in the lane for no more than the permitted distance.

(5)In this regulation —

permitted distance means —

(a)for a bicycle lane — 50 m; or

(b)for any other lane — 100 m.

[Regulation 136 amended: SL 2020/184 r. 15.]

137.Marked lanes required to be used by particular kinds of vehicles

(1)If information on or with a traffic sign applying to a length of carriageway indicates that a vehicle of a particular kind must drive in a particular marked lane, a driver driving a vehicle of that kind on the length of carriageway must drive in the indicated lane, unless the driver is —

(a)avoiding an obstruction; or

(b)obeying a traffic‑control signal applying to the indicated lane; or

(c)intending to turn off the carriageway or to make a U turn, and in order to do so safely without disrupting other vehicles on the carriageway it is necessary to position the vehicle in another lane before starting the turn, or to make the turn.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A traffic sign that is on a carriageway applies to the length of carriageway beginning at the sign and ending at the nearest of the following:

(a)a traffic sign or road marking on the carriageway that indicates that the first traffic sign no longer applies;

(b)if the carriageway ends at a T‑intersection or dead end — the end of the carriageway.

Examples of a traffic sign, and a traffic sign indicating that the first traffic sign no longer applies

Trucks use left lane sign

End trucks use left lane sign

Note   There is another permitted version of the “trucks use left lane” sign.

[Regulation 137 amended: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5752; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 6A — Stationary incident response vehicles

[Heading inserted: Gazette 5 Jan 2018 p. 9.]

137A.Approaching and passing stationary incident response vehicles

(1)In this regulation —

hazard warning light has the same meaning as in regulation 188;

incident response vehicle means any of the following vehicles if the vehicle is displaying a flashing light other than a turn indicator light or hazard warning light —

(a)an emergency vehicle;

(b)a motor break‑down service vehicle;

(c)a tow truck;

(d)a vehicle that is being used to provide an incident response service on behalf of the Commissioner of Main Roads.

(2)A driver approaching a stationary incident response vehicle must drive at a speed at which the driver can, if necessary, stop safely before passing the incident response vehicle.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(3)A driver approaching a stationary incident response vehicle that is in the same lane of a multi‑lane carriageway as the driver must move to another lane for vehicular traffic travelling in the same direction as the driver, if it is safe to do so.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(4)A driver must not pass a stationary incident response vehicle at a speed exceeding 40 km/h.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(5)Subregulations (2) and (4) do not apply if the driver —

(a)is on a two‑way carriageway; and

(b)the incident response vehicle is on the side of the carriageway used by vehicular traffic travelling in the opposite direction to the driver.

[Regulation 137A inserted: Gazette 5 Jan 2018 p. 9‑10.]

Division 7 — Freight containers

[Heading inserted: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4921.]

138A.Freight container not to be driven on prohibited road

(1)In this regulation —

freight container has the meaning given in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Act 2012 section 3(1);

O’Connor Industrial Area means the area described in Schedule 5 which includes the portions of roads described as bordering that area;

prohibited road means South Street between the intersections of South Street and the Kwinana Freeway and South Street and Stock Road.

(2)A person must not drive a vehicle carrying a freight container on any part of the prohibited road.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)Subregulation (2) does not apply to a vehicle that is carrying a freight container for delivery to, or collection from, an address —

(a)on the prohibited road; or

(b)within the O’Connor Industrial Area.

(4)The commission of an offence under subregulation (2) is not affected by whether or not signage mentioned in regulation 138B is displayed.

[Regulation 138A inserted: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4921‑2.]

138B.Signs

The Commissioner of Main Roads may authorise the display of signage to inform the public of the prohibition in regulation 138A.

[Regulation 138B inserted: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4922.]

Part 12Restrictions on stopping and parking

Division 1General

138.Stopping in an emergency etc. or to comply with another regulation

It is a defence to the prosecution of a driver for an offence against a provision of this Part, or against a regulation that refers to this regulation, if —

(a)the driver stops at a particular place, or in a particular way, to avoid a collision, and the driver stops for no longer than is necessary to avoid the collision; or

(b)the driver stops at a particular place, or in a particular way, because the driver’s vehicle is disabled, and the driver stops for no longer than is necessary for the vehicle to be moved safely to a place where the driver is permitted to park the vehicle under these regulations; or

(c)the driver stops at a particular place, or in a particular way, because the driver or a passenger is assisting with a disabled vehicle, and the driver stops for no longer than is necessary for the disabled vehicle to be moved safely to a place where the driver of the disabled vehicle is permitted to park that vehicle under these regulations; or

(d)the driver stops at a particular place, or in a particular way, to deal with a medical or other emergency, and the driver stops for no longer than is necessary in the circumstances; or

(e)the driver stops at a particular place, or in a particular way, because the condition of the driver, a passenger, or the driver’s vehicle makes it necessary for the driver to stop in the interests of safety, and the driver stops for no longer than is necessary in the circumstances; or

(f)the driver stops at a particular place, or in a particular way, to comply with another provision of these regulations or a provision of another law, and the driver stops for no longer than is necessary to comply with the other provision.

Example for paragraph (e)

If a driver stops at an intersection at a stop line, “stop” sign, or traffic‑control signals, or to give way to a vehicle, in accordance with these regulations, the driver does not commit an offence under a regulation prohibiting the driver from stopping in or near an intersection.

139.Application of this Part to bicycles

This Part does not apply to a bicycle that is parked at a bicycle rail or in a bicycle rack.

Division 2No stopping and no parking signs, and yellow edge lines

140.No stopping signs

A driver must not stop on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a “no stopping” sign applies.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

No stopping signs

No stopping sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(circle, slash and arrow in red)

No stopping sign
(for an area)

(circle and slash in red)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of these signs.

Note   A “no stopping” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and anything on the sign may be differently arranged.

[Regulation 140 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

141.No parking signs

(1)A driver must not stop on a length of carriageway or in an area to which a “no parking” sign applies, unless the driver —

(a)is dropping off, or picking up, passengers or goods; and

(b)does not leave the vehicle unattended; and

(c)completes the dropping off, or picking up, of the passengers or goods, and drives on, as soon as possible and, in any case, within the required time after stopping.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)In this regulation —

required time means —

(a)if information on or with the sign indicates a time — the indicated time; or

(b)if there is no indicated time — 2 minutes; or

(c)if there is no indicated time, or the indicated time is less than 5 minutes, and regulation 174 applies to the driver — 5 minutes;

unattended, in relation to a vehicle, means that the driver has left the vehicle so that the driver is more than 3 m from the closest point of the vehicle.

No parking signs

No parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(circle, slash and arrow in red)

No parking sign
(for an area)

(circle and slash in red

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of each of these signs.

Note   A “no parking” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and anything on the sign may be differently arranged.

[Regulation 141 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4592; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

142.No stopping on carriageway with yellow edge line

A driver must not stop at the side of a carriageway marked with a continuous yellow edge line.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 142 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 3Stopping at intersections and crossings

143.Prohibited stopping places

(1)A person must not stop a vehicle so that any portion of the vehicle is in an intersection, unless permitted to do so by this regulation.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A person must not stop a vehicle on a carriageway within 20 m from the nearest point of an intersecting carriageway at an intersection with traffic‑control signals, unless the driver stops at a place on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the driver is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)A person must not stop a vehicle on a carriageway so that any portion of the vehicle is within 10 m of the prolongation of the nearer edge of any intersecting carriageway (without traffic‑control signals) intersecting that carriageway on the side on which the vehicle is stopped, unless the person stops —

(a)at a place on a carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the person is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations; or

(b)if the intersection is a T‑intersection — along the continuous side of the continuing road at the intersection.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Example 1

Measurement of distance — intersection with traffic‑control signals

Example 2

Measurement of distance — T‑intersection without traffic lights

(4)For this regulation, distances are measured in the direction in which the person is or was driving and, where applicable — as shown in the examples.

[Regulation 143 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

144.Stopping on or near children’s crossing or pedestrian crossing

(1)This regulation does not apply to a pedestrian crossing at an intersection.

(2A)This regulation does not apply if regulation 62(5) applies.

(2)A person must not stop a vehicle so that any portion of the vehicle is —

(a)within 20 m of the approach side of a pedestrian crossing or children’s crossing; or

(b)within 10 m of the departure side of a pedestrian crossing or children’s crossing,

unless the person stops the vehicle at a place on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the person is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)For this regulation, distances are measured in the direction in which the person is or was driving, and as shown in the examples.

Example 1

Measurement of distance — children’s crossing

Example 2

Measurement of distance — pedestrian crossing

[Regulation 144 amended: Gazette 31 Dec 2013 p. 6565; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

145.Stopping on or near marked foot crossing (except at intersection)

(1)A driver must not stop on a marked foot crossing that is not at an intersection, or on the carriageway within 10 m before the traffic‑control signal pole nearest to the driver at the marked foot crossing and 3 m after the marked foot crossing, unless the person stops the vehicle at a place on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the person is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A driver must not enter upon, or attempt to cross, a marked foot crossing if the carriageway beyond it is blocked.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Examples

The carriageway beyond the crossing may be blocked by congested traffic, a disabled vehicle, a collision between vehicles or between a vehicle and a pedestrian, or by a fallen load on the carriageway.

(3)For this regulation, distances are measured in the direction in which the person is or was driving, and as shown in the example.

Example

Measurement of distance — marked foot crossing

[Regulation 145 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

146.Stopping at or near bicycle crossing lights (except at intersection)

(1)This regulation applies to a place on a carriageway —

(a)with bicycle crossing lights facing bicycle riders crossing the carriageway; and

(b)with traffic‑control signals facing traffic travelling on the carriageway; and

(c)that is not at an intersection.

(2)A person must not stop a vehicle within 10 m before the traffic‑control signals nearest to the person at the place, and 3 m after the traffic‑control signals, unless the person stops the vehicle at a place on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the person is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)For this regulation, distances are measured in the direction in which the person is or was driving, and as shown in the example.

Example

Measurement of distance — bicycle crossing lights

[Regulation 146 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

147.Stopping on or near level crossing

(1)A person must not stop a vehicle on a level crossing, or on a carriageway within 20 m before the nearest rail or track to a driver approaching the crossing and 20 m after the nearest rail or track to a driver leaving the crossing, unless the person stops the vehicle at a place on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the person is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)For this regulation, distances are measured in the direction in which the person is or was driving, and as shown in the example.

Example

Measurement of distance — level crossing

[Regulation 147 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 4Stopping on clearways and freeways and in emergency stopping bays and lanes and red X lanes

[Heading amended: SL 2020/184 r. 16.]

148.Stopping on clearway

(1)Subject to subregulations (2) and (3), a driver must not stop on a length of carriageway to which a “clearway” sign applies.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)The driver of a public bus may stop on the length of carriageway to which a “clearway” sign applies, if the driver is dropping off, or picking up, passengers.

(3)Where there is a length of carriageway to which a “clearway” sign generally applies, and there is also a “permissive parking” sign applying specifically to a part of the carriageway permitting stopping for a certain period during which that part of the carriageway would otherwise be a clearway, a driver may stop on that part of the carriageway at that time, but for no longer than is allowed by the “permissive parking” sign.

(4)Subject to subregulation (3), a “clearway” sign applies, for the days and times indicated on the sign, to a length of carriageway beginning at the sign and ending at the nearest of the following —

(a)a “clearway” sign on the carriageway that indicates different days or times;

(b)an “end clearway” sign on the carriageway;

(c)the end of the carriageway.

Clearway sign

(background to C in red)

End clearway sign

(background to C in red)

Note   Anything on these signs may be differently arranged.

[Regulation 148 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4593; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

149.Stopping on freeway

(1)A driver must not stop on a freeway unless —

(a)the driver stops in an emergency stopping bay, an emergency stopping lane or a red X lane; or

(b)the driver’s vehicle is permitted to stop on the freeway under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)For the purposes of subregulation (1), a “freeway” sign on a carriageway applies to the length of road (including any median strip or consolidated shoulder and any other part of the freeway enclosure) beginning at the sign (including any road into which the length of road merges) and ending at the next “end freeway” sign on the carriageway.

Freeway signs

(background and outer edge in green)

End freeway sign

(background and outer edge in green)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of each of these signs.

[Regulation 149 amended: SL 2020/184 r. 17; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

150.Stopping in emergency stopping bay, emergency stopping lane or red X lane

The driver of a vehicle (other than a bicycle) must not stop in an emergency stopping bay, an emergency stopping lane or a red X lane, unless —

(a)all of the following apply —

(i)the driver, a passenger or the vehicle itself, encounters the rapid and unexpected onset of a situation as a result of which the health or safety of the driver or a passenger is at risk;

(ii)immediate action is required to address the risk;

(iii)the driver stops for no longer than is necessary in the circumstances;

or

(b)the driver’s vehicle is disabled and the driver stops for no longer than is necessary in the circumstances; or

(c)the driver’s vehicle is permitted to stop in the emergency stopping bay, emergency stopping lane or red X lane under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Emergency stopping bay signs

(background to “emergency” in red)

(background to phone in blue)

Emergency Stopping Bay Only

Emergency stopping lane only sign

[Regulation 150 inserted: SL 2020/184 r. 18.]

Division 5Stopping in zones for particular vehicles

151.Stopping in loading zone

A person must not stop a vehicle in a loading zone unless it is —

(a)a motor vehicle used for commercial or trade purposes engaged in the picking up or setting down of goods; or

(b)a motor vehicle taking up or setting down passengers,

but, in any event, must not remain in that loading zone —

(c)for longer than a time indicated on the “loading zone” sign; or

(d)longer than 30 minutes (if no time is indicated on the sign).

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Loading zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   A “loading zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction.

[Regulation 151 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

152.Stopping in truck zone

A person must not stop a vehicle in a truck zone unless it is —

(a)a truck that is dropping off, or picking up, goods; or

(b)a vehicle that is permitted to stop in the truck zone under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Truck zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   A “truck zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction.

[Regulation 152 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

153.Stopping in works zone etc.

(1)A person must not stop a vehicle in a works zone unless the person is driving a vehicle that is —

(a)engaged in construction work in or near the zone; or

(b)permitted to stop in the works zone under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Works zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   A “works zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction.

(2)A driver must not stop alongside, or opposite, any excavation in the carriageway, if the driver’s vehicle would thereby obstruct traffic.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 153 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

154.Stopping in taxi zone or bus zone

(1)A driver must not stop in a taxi zone, unless the driver is driving a taxi.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Taxi zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   A “taxi zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and has a number of alternative signs.

(2)A driver must not stop in a bus zone unless the driver is driving a public bus, or a bus of a type that is permitted to stop at the bus zone by information on or with the “bus zone” sign applying to the bus zone.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Bus zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   A “bus zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and may specify types of buses to which the sign applies.

[Regulation 154 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

155.Stopping in mail zone

A person must not stop a vehicle in a mail zone.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Mail zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

Note   A “mail zone” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction.

[Regulation 155 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

156.Other limitations in zones

A person must not stop a vehicle in a zone to which a traffic sign applies if stopping the vehicle would be contrary to any limitation in respect to classes of persons or vehicles, or specific activities allowed, as indicated by additional words on a traffic sign that applies to the zone.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 156 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 6Other places where stopping is restricted

157.Stopping in bus lane, transit lane, truck lane or bicycle lane

A driver must not stop in —

(a)a bus lane; or

(b)a transit lane; or

(c)a truck lane; or

(d)a bicycle lane,

unless the driver is driving a public bus or taxi, and is dropping off, or picking up, passengers.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 157 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

158.Stopping in shared zone

A driver must not stop in a shared zone unless —

(a)the driver stops at a place on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the driver is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations; or

(b)the driver stops in a parking bay and the driver is permitted to stop in the parking bay under these regulations; or

(c)the driver is dropping off, or picking up, passengers or goods; or

(d)the driver is engaged in the door‑to‑door delivery or collection of goods, or in the collection of waste or garbage.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 158 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

159.Double parking

(1)A driver must not stop a vehicle so that any portion of the vehicle is between any other stopped vehicle and the centre of the carriageway.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)This regulation does not apply to —

(a)a driver stopped in traffic; or

(b)a driver angle parking on the side of the carriageway or in a median strip parking area, in accordance with regulation 178.

Examples

Example 1

In example 1, the vehicle B is stopped in contravention of this regulation.

Example 2

Rule 189

In example 2, the angle parked vehicles are not stopped in contravention of this regulation.

[Regulation 159 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

160.Stopping near obstruction

A driver must not stop on a carriageway near an obstruction on the carriageway in a position that further obstructs traffic on the carriageway.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 160 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

161.Stopping on bridge or in tunnel etc.

(1)A driver must not stop a vehicle on a bridge, causeway, ramp or similar structure unless —

(a)the carriageway is at least as wide on the structure as it is on each of the approaches and a traffic sign does not prohibit stopping or parking; or

(b)the driver stops at a place on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the driver is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A driver must not stop a vehicle in a tunnel or underpass unless —

(a)the carriageway is at least as wide in the tunnel or underpass as it is on each of the approaches and a traffic sign does not prohibit stopping or parking; or

(b)the driver of a motor vehicle stops at a bus stop, or in a bus zone or parking area marked on the carriageway, for the purpose of setting down or taking up passengers.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Example

Stopping on a bridge where the carriageway on the bridge is narrower than on an approach

In the example, the vehicle is stopped in contravention of subregulation (1).

[Regulation 161 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

162.Restriction on stopping vehicle on crests, curves etc.

(1)Subject to subregulation (2), a driver must not stop a vehicle on, or partly on, a carriageway, in any position where it is not visible to the driver of an overtaking vehicle, from a distance of 50 m, within a built‑up area, and from a distance of 150 m, outside a built‑up area.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A driver may stop on a crest or curve on a carriageway that is not in a built‑up area if the driver stops at a place on the carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the driver is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations.

[Regulation 162 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

163.Stopping near fire hydrant etc.

(1)A driver must not stop a vehicle so that any portion of the vehicle is within 1 m of a fire hydrant or fire plug, or of any sign or mark indicating the existence of a fire hydrant or fire plug, unless —

(a)the driver is driving a public bus, and the driver stops in a bus zone or at a bus stop and does not leave the bus unattended; or

(b)the driver is driving a taxi, and the driver stops in a taxi zone and does not leave the taxi unattended.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Examples

Fire hydrant indicators

Fire plug indicator

(2)In this regulation a driver leaves a vehicle unattended if the driver leaves the vehicle so the driver is over 3 m from the closest point of the vehicle.

[Regulation 163 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

164.Stopping at or near bus stop

(1)A driver must not stop a vehicle so that any portion of the vehicle is within 20 m of the approach side of a bus stop, or within 10 m of the departure side of a bus stop, unless —

(a)the vehicle is a public bus stopped to take up or set down passengers; or

(b)the driver stops at a place on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the driver is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)In this regulation —

(a)distances are measured in the direction in which the driver is driving; and

(b)a trailer attached to a public bus is deemed to be a part of the public bus.

[Regulation 164 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

165.Stopping on path, dividing strip, nature strip or painted island

The driver of a vehicle (other than a bicycle, an EPT or an animal) must not stop so that any portion of the vehicle is on a path, dividing strip, painted island, or a nature strip adjacent to a length of carriageway in a built‑up area, unless —

(a)the driver stops in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the driver is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations; or

(b)the driver is permitted to do so under a local law.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 165 inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4593; amended: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1534; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

166.Obstructing access to and from path, driveway etc.

(1)A driver must not stop a vehicle so that any portion of the vehicle is in front of a path, in a position that obstructs access by vehicles or pedestrians to or from that path, unless —

(a)the driver is dropping off, or picking up, passengers; or

(b)the driver stops in a parking bay and the driver is permitted to stop in the parking bay under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A driver must not stop a vehicle on or across a driveway or other way of access for a vehicle travelling to or from adjacent land, unless —

(a)the driver is dropping off, or picking up, passengers; or

(b)the driver stops in a parking bay and the driver is permitted to stop in the parking bay under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Example

Blocking a driveway

In the example, the vehicle marked with an ‘X’ is stopped in contravention of subregulation (2).

[Regulation 166 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

167.Stopping near letter box

A driver must not stop a vehicle so that any portion of the vehicle is within 3 m of a public letter box, unless the driver —

(a)is dropping off, or picking up, passengers or mail; or

(b)stops at a place on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign applies and the driver is permitted to stop at that place under these regulations.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 167 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

168.Stopping on carriageway — heavy and long vehicles

(1)A person must not park a vehicle or any combination of vehicles that, together with any projection on, or load carried by, the vehicle or combination of vehicles, is 7.5 m in length or longer or exceeds a GVM of 4.5 t —

(a)on a carriageway in a built‑up area, for any period exceeding one hour, unless engaged in the picking up or setting down of goods; or

(b)on a carriageway outside a built‑up area, except on the shoulder of the carriageway, or in a truck bay or other area set aside for the parking of goods vehicles.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)Nothing in this regulation mitigates the limitations or conditions imposed by any other regulation or by any local law or traffic sign relating to the parking or stopping of vehicles.

[Regulation 168 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6754; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

169.Stopping on carriageway with bicycle parking sign

The driver of a vehicle (other than a bicycle) must not stop on a length of carriageway to which a “bicycle parking” sign applies, unless the driver is dropping off, or picking up, passengers.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Bicycle parking sign

(letter, word, symbol and arrow in green)

Note   Anything on this sign may be differently arranged.

[Regulation 169 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

170.Stopping on carriageway with motor cycle parking sign

The driver of a vehicle must not stop on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a “motor cycle parking” sign applies, or an area marked “M/C”, unless —

(a)the vehicle is a motor cycle; or

(b)the driver is dropping off, or picking up, passengers.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Motor cycle parking sign

(letter, words and arrow in green)

Note   Anything on this sign may be differently arranged.

[Regulation 170 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

171.Stopping in parking area for people with disabilities

(1)A driver must not stop in a parking area for people with disabilities unless —

(a)the driver’s vehicle displays a disability parking permit; and

(b)either the driver or a passenger in that vehicle is a person with disabilities.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)In this regulation, a parking area for people with disabilities is a length or area of a road —

(a)to which a “permissive parking” sign displaying a people with disabilities symbol applies; or

(b)to which a “people with disabilities parking” sign applies; or

(c)indicated by a road marking (a “people with disabilities road marking”) that consists of, or includes, a people with disabilities symbol; or

(d)set aside within a parking region as a permit parking area as defined in the Local Government (Parking for People with Disabilities) Regulations 2014 regulation 4.

People with disabilities symbols

(background in blue)(symbol in blue)

Permissive parking sign displaying a people with disabilities symbol
(for a length of
carriageway)

(letter and arrow in green, word and background to symbol in blue)

Permissive parking sign displaying a people with disabilities symbol
(for an area)

(letter in green, background to symbol in blue, words in black)

People with disabilities parking sign

(background to symbol in blue)

Note   Anything on these signs may be differently arranged.

[Regulation 171 amended: Gazette 13 Feb 2015 p. 651‑2; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 7Permissive parking signs and parking fees

172.Information on or with permissive parking signs

(1)The meaning of information on or with a “permissive parking” sign applying to a length of carriageway or an area is to be interpreted in accordance with this regulation.

Permissive parking sign

(for a length of carriageway)

(arrow and letter in green)

Permissive parking sign

(for an area)

(letter in green, words in black)

Permissive parking sign

(for a length of carriageway)

(arrow, letter and words in green)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of each of these signs.

Note   A “permissive parking” sign may have an arrow pointing in a different direction and anything on the sign may be differently arranged.

(2A)If a permissive parking sign does not indicate a period and does not indicate that it applies at particular times, or at particular times on particular days, a driver may, at any time, park continuously on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which the sign applies, unless —

(a)another parking control sign applies to the length of carriageway or area; and

(b)the driver is prohibited from parking on the length of carriageway, or in the area, under these regulations.

(2)A whole number, fraction, or whole number and fraction, immediately to the left of the letter ‘P’ indicates that a driver must not park on the length of carriageway, or in the area, continuously for longer than the period of hours, or fraction of an hour, equal to the number, fraction, or number and fraction, shown.

Examples of permissive parking signs showing permitted parking periods and times of operation

Example 1

Permissive parking sign
applying to a length of carriageway with a whole number to the left of P

(arrow, and all numbers and letters, in green)

Example 2

Permissive parking sign
applying to an area with a whole number to the left of P

(“2P” in green; other numbers, letters and words in black)

In example 1, the sign indicates that a driver must not park continuously for longer than one hour on Saturdays between 9 am and 12 noon.

In example 2, the sign indicates that a driver must not park in the area for longer than 2 hours on Mondays to Fridays between 8.30 am and 5 pm, and on Saturdays between 8.30 am and 12 noon, unless permitted by information on or with another traffic sign.

(3)A number, together with the word ‘minute’, immediately to the right of the letter ‘P’ indicate that a driver must not park on the length of carriageway, or in the area, continuously for longer than the number of minutes shown.

Example

Example 3

Permissive parking sign with a number of minutes to the right of P

(arrow, and all numbers and letters, in green)

In this example, the sign indicates that a driver must not park continuously for longer than 5 minutes on Mondays to Fridays between 9 am and 4 pm.

(4)The word ‘parking’, together with words indicating a number of hours or minutes, indicate that a driver must not park on the length of carriageway, or in the area, continuously for longer than the number of hours or minutes shown.

[Regulation 172 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4594.]

173A.Parking outside times indicated

If a permissive parking sign indicates that it applies at particular times, or at particular times on particular days, a driver may park on the length of carriageway, or in an area, to which the sign applies at a time, or at a time on a day, when the sign does not apply, unless —

(a)another parking control sign applies to the length of carriageway or area; and

(b)the driver is prohibited from parking on the length of carriageway, or in the area, at that time, or at that time on that day, under these regulations.

[Regulation 173A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4594.]

173.Parking for longer than indicated

A driver must not park continuously on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a “permissive parking” sign applies, for longer than —

(a)the period indicated by information on or with the sign; or

(b)if regulation 174 applies to the driver — the period allowed under that regulation.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 173 amended: Gazette 31 Dec 2013 p. 6565; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

174.Time extension for people with disabilities

(1)This regulation applies to a driver if —

(a)the driver’s vehicle displays a disability parking permit; and

(b)a person with a disability is either the driver of or a passenger in the vehicle.

(2)The driver may park continuously on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a “permissive parking” sign applies (except in a parking area for people with disabilities) —

(a)if the time limit indicated on or with the sign is under 30 minutes — for 30 minutes;

(b)if the time limit indicated on or with the sign is between 30 and 60 minutes — for 2 hours;

(c)if the time limit indicated on or with the sign is over 60 minutes — for twice the period indicated on the sign.

(3)Despite subregulation (2), if another law of the State permits the driver to park for a longer period than that allowed by subregulation (2), or for an unlimited period, the driver may park for that longer period of time.

[Regulation 174 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6754; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6565-6; 13 Feb 2015 p. 652.]

175.Parking where fees are payable

(1)This regulation applies to the driver of a vehicle when the vehicle is parked on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a “permissive parking” sign applies, if information on or with the sign indicates that a fee is payable for parking by buying a ticket or putting money into a parking meter.

(2)The driver of a vehicle must ensure that —

(a)the fee (if any) is paid immediately after the vehicle is parked; and

(b)the vehicle is parked in compliance with any instructions on or with the sign, meter, ticket or ticket‑vending machine.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 175 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 8Parallel parking

176.Parallel parking on carriageway (except in median strip parking area)

(1)The driver of a vehicle who parks on a carriageway (except in a median strip parking area) must position the vehicle in accordance with subregulations (2) to (8), (subject to the exceptions in subregulations (9) and (10)).

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)The driver of a vehicle must position the vehicle to face in the direction of travel of vehicles in the marked lane or line of traffic on, or next to, the part of the carriageway where the driver parks.

(3)If a carriageway is a two‑way carriageway, the driver of a vehicle must position the vehicle so that it is as near as practicable to, and parallel with, the left boundary of the carriageway.

(4)If the carriageway is a one‑way carriageway the driver of a vehicle must position the vehicle so that it is as near as practicable to, and parallel with, either boundary of the carriageway unless otherwise indicated by information on or with a parking control sign.

(5)If the driver of a vehicle does not park in a parking bay, the driver must position the vehicle so that it is not less than 1 m from any other vehicle, except a motor cycle without a trailer parked in accordance with these regulations.

(6)If the carriageway has a continuous dividing line, dividing strip or a median strip, the driver of a vehicle must position the vehicle at least 3 m from the continuous line, dividing strip or median strip, unless otherwise indicated by information on or with a parking control sign.

Example

Parallel parking — minimum distance from other vehicles and dividing strip

Test for davebmp

In the example, the vehicles marked with an ‘X’ are parked in contravention of this regulation.

(7)If the carriageway does not have a continuous dividing line or a median strip, the driver of a vehicle must position the vehicle so there is at least 3 m of the carriageway alongside the vehicle that is clear for other vehicles to pass, unless otherwise indicated by information on or with a parking control sign.

(8)The driver of a vehicle must position the vehicle so the vehicle does not cause undue obstruction on the carriageway.

(9)This regulation does not apply to —

(a)the driver of a vehicle if the driver parks on a length of carriageway, or in an area, to which a parking control sign or road marking applies, and information on or with the sign or road marking includes the words ‘angle parking’ or ‘angle’; or

(b)subject to subregulation (10), the rider of a motor cycle.

(10)Subregulations (3) and (4) do not apply to the rider of a motor cycle if the rider positions the motor cycle so at least one wheel is as near as practicable to the far left or far right side of the carriageway.

(11)If a carriageway has one or more service roads, the part of the carriageway used by the main body of moving vehicles, and each service road, is taken to be a separate carriageway for this regulation.

(12)In this regulation —

continuous dividing line means —

(a)a single continuous dividing line only; or

(b)a single continuous dividing line to the left or right of a broken dividing line; or

(c)2 parallel continuous dividing lines.

[Regulation 176 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4168; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4595; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

177.Parallel parking in median strip parking area

(1)This regulation applies to the driver of a vehicle (other than a motor cycle) who parks in a median strip parking area if a parking control sign or road marking applies to the area, and information on or with the sign or road marking indicates that the vehicle must be positioned parallel to the median strip.

(2)The driver of a vehicle must position the vehicle —

(a)to face in the direction of travel of vehicles in the marked lane or line of traffic to the left of the driver; and

(b)parallel, and as near as practicable, to the centre of the median strip; and

(c)if the driver does not park in a parking bay — at least 1 m from the closest point of any vehicle in front of it and any vehicle behind it.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 177 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 9Angle parking

178.Angle parking

(1)This regulation applies to the driver of a vehicle (other than a motor cycle) who parks in a parking area on the side of a carriageway, or in a median strip parking area, to which a parking control sign or road marking applies, and information on or with the sign or road marking includes the words ‘angle parking’ or ‘angle’.

(2)If information on or with the parking control sign or road marking indicates that the driver’s vehicle must be positioned at an angle of 45°, or does not indicate a particular angle, the driver must position the vehicle —

(a)so the vehicle is at an angle as near as practicable to 45° (as shown in example 1 or 2); and

(b)if the vehicle is parked on the side of a carriageway — with the rear of the vehicle nearest to traffic in the marked lane or line of traffic next to the part of the carriageway where the driver parks.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Examples

Example 1

Parking at 45°
at the side of a two
‑way carriageway

Example 2

Parking at 45°
at the right side of a one
‑way carriageway

(3)If information on or with the parking control sign or road marking indicates that the driver’s vehicle must be positioned at an angle of 90°, the driver —

(a)must position the vehicle so the vehicle is at an angle as near as practicable to 90° (as shown in example 3 or 4); and

(b)if the vehicle is parked on the side of a carriageway — may position the vehicle with either the front or rear of the vehicle nearest to traffic in the marked lane or line of traffic next to the part of the carriageway where the driver parks.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Examples

Example 3

Parking at 90°
at the side of a two
‑way carriageway

Example 4

Parking at 90°
at the right side of a one
‑way carriageway

(4)If information on or with the parking control sign or road marking indicates that the driver’s vehicle must be positioned at an angle of 135°, the driver must position the vehicle —

(a)so the vehicle is at an angle as near as practicable to 135° (as shown in example 5 or 6); and

(b)if the vehicle is parked on the side of a carriageway — with the front of the vehicle nearest to traffic in the marked lane or line of traffic next to the part of the carriageway where the driver parks.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Examples

Example 5

Parking at 135°
at the side of a carriageway

Example 6

Parking at 135°
in a median strip parking area

(5)If information on or with the parking control sign or road marking indicates that the driver’s vehicle must be positioned at a particular angle, the driver must position the vehicle —

(a)so the vehicle is at an angle as near as practicable to the specified angle; and

(b)if the vehicle is parked on the side of a carriageway — with the rear of the vehicle nearest to the centre of the carriageway.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 178 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4595; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6566; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 10Other parking related provisions

179.Parking in parking bays

(1)Subject to subregulation (2), a driver parking a vehicle on a length of carriageway, or in an area, on which parking bays are marked (whether or not a “park in bays only” sign applies) must position the vehicle completely within a single bay.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Park in bays only sign

(2)If a vehicle is too wide or long to fit completely within a single parking bay, the person stopping the vehicle must park the vehicle within the minimum number of parking bays needed to park that vehicle.

(3)A driver must not stop a vehicle partly within and partly outside a parking area.

[Regulation 179 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4595‑6; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

180.Entering and leaving median strip parking area

(1)If information on or with a road sign indicates that a driver must enter or leave a median strip parking area in a particular direction, the driver must enter or leave the area in that direction.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)If there is no information on or with a road sign that indicates that a driver must enter or leave a median strip parking area in a particular direction, the driver must not drive a vehicle in reverse out of a parking area established across the centre of a carriageway, if the carriageway or parking area in front of the vehicle is free from obstruction.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Leaving median strip parking area by driving forward

[Regulation 180 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

181.Making motor vehicle secure

(1)A driver of a motor vehicle must not stop and leave the motor vehicle without first —

(a)stopping the engine; and

(b)effectively applying the brake; and

(c)if weather or road conditions would prevent the effective operation of the brake — effectively restraining the vehicle’s movements in another way.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)If the driver of a motor vehicle stops and leaves the motor vehicle, and a person 16 years of age or older does not remain in or with the motor vehicle, the driver must also secure the motor vehicle by —

(a)locking the ignition, if any; and

(b)removing the ignition key, if any; and

(c)locking the doors — if the doors of the vehicle can be locked; and

(d)securing the windows — if the windows of the vehicle can be secured,

unless the driver has only temporarily left the motor vehicle to pay a fee for parking that motor vehicle.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)A person having the control of, or being in charge of, a vehicle to which is fitted any appliance capable of being raised or lowered must not leave the vehicle stopped unless —

(a)the appliance has been placed in its lowest practicable position; and

(b)every precaution has been taken to prevent injury to persons or damage to property arising from the inherent nature of the appliance and the fact of the vehicle being unattended.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)For the purposes of this regulation —

(a)a person leaves a vehicle if the person is more than 3 m from the closest point of the vehicle; and

(b)an appliance includes a fork lift, loader, push‑bar, scraper, blade, jib or similar device; and

(c)a window is secure even if it is open by up to 2 cm.

[Regulation 181 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4596‑7; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 13Lights and warning devices

Division 1Lights on motor vehicles

182.Lights on moving motor vehicles

A person must not drive a motor vehicle or a combination of a motor vehicle and trailer, during the hours of darkness or in hazardous weather conditions restricting visibility, unless it is equipped with such lights and reflectors as are prescribed by the Vehicle Standards as those to be carried by that vehicle or combination, and the lights are lit.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 182 amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4922; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

183.Using fog lights

(1)The driver of a vehicle fitted with a front or rear fog light must not operate the front or the rear fog light unless the driver is driving in fog or other hazardous weather conditions causing reduced visibility.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)In fog or mist or in hazardous weather conditions restricting visibility, the display of light from a front fog light or front fog lights is sufficient compliance with any obligation to display a light from a head light or head lights under regulation 182.

(3)A person must not drive a motor vehicle, other than a motor cycle, displaying light from a single front fog light, unless 2 lit lights, complying with the requirements of the Vehicle Standards, are fitted to the front of the vehicle.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)A person must not drive a motor vehicle displaying light from a front fog light or front fog lights, if any other light of a power exceeding 7 watts and capable of showing a white light to the front is alight.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 183 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

184.Lights on towed vehicles

(1)A person must not tow a vehicle, during the hours of darkness or in hazardous weather conditions restricting visibility, unless it is equipped with the appropriate lights as prescribed by the Vehicle Standards, and the lights are lit.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)The driver of a tow truck must not tow a vehicle unless it is fitted with the equipment referred to in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 410(2) and such equipment is operating correctly in accordance with the Vehicle Standards.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)Subregulation (2) does not apply to the driver of a tow truck if —

(a)the driver is towing a disabled vehicle carrying a placard load of dangerous goods to a place that is safely off the carriageway; and

(b)a vehicle carrying a warning to other traffic is following immediately behind the disabled vehicle.

(4)In subregulation (3) —

dangerous goods has the meaning given in the Dangerous Goods Safety (Road and Rail Transport of Non‑explosives) Regulations 2007 regulation 28;

placard load has the meaning given in the Dangerous Goods Safety (Road and Rail Transport of Non‑explosives) Regulations 2007 regulation 4.

[Regulation 184 amended: Gazette 1 Nov 2002 p. 5398; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4922‑3; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

185.Using headlights on high‑beam

(1)Subject to subregulation (2), the driver of a vehicle must not use the vehicle’s headlights on high‑beam, or allow the vehicle’s headlights to be used on high‑beam —

(a)if the driver is driving less than 200 m behind a vehicle travelling in the same direction as the driver; or

(b)if the driver is driving less than 200 m from an oncoming vehicle; or

(c)if the headlights of an oncoming vehicle are dipped.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)Despite subregulation (1), if the driver is overtaking a vehicle, the driver may briefly switch the headlights from low‑beam to high‑beam immediately before the driver begins to overtake the vehicle.

Examples

Example 1

Using headlights on low‑beam when travelling less
than 200 m behind another vehicle travelling in

the same direction

Example 2

Using headlights on low‑beam when travelling within
200 m of an oncoming vehicle

[Regulation 185 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

186.Lights not to be used to dazzle other road users

(1)A person must not cause or permit a spot light or search light fitted or connected to any vehicle to be used to dazzle, or to be used in a manner likely to dazzle, another road user.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)The provisions of subregulation (1) do not apply to an emergency vehicle or a special purpose vehicle being used in connection with its functions.

[Regulation 186 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5820; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

187.Using lights on some stopped vehicles

(1)A person must not stop a motor vehicle or a trailer, on, or partly on, a carriageway, during the hours of darkness, unless the parking lights fitted to the motor vehicle or the trailer, and any clearance and side marker lights required by the Vehicle Standards to be fitted to the motor vehicle or trailer are operating effectively and are clearly visible.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply in respect of the lighting of parking lights or clearance and side marker lights —

(a)where the street lighting in the vicinity renders the motor vehicle or the trailer clearly visible at a distance of 200 m; or

(b)on a motor cycle not connected to a side‑car or trailer, stopped as near as practicable to, and parallel with, the boundary of the carriageway.

[Regulation 187 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

188.Using hazard warning lights

(1)The driver of a motor vehicle fitted with hazard warning lights must not use the hazard warning lights, or allow them to be used, unless —

(a)the vehicle is stopped and is obstructing, or is likely to obstruct, the path of other vehicles or pedestrians; or

(b)the vehicle is a slow‑moving vehicle and is obstructing, or is likely to obstruct, the path of other vehicles or pedestrians; or

(c)the vehicle is stopped in an emergency stopping bay, an emergency stopping lane or a red X lane; or

(d)the driver stops the vehicle to sell a product (for example, ice creams) that may attract children onto the carriageway; or

(e)the driver is driving in hazardous weather conditions (for example, fog or smoke); or

(f)the vehicle is a bus carrying children, and the driver stops the vehicle to drop off or pick up a child; or

(g)the hazard warning lights are operating as part of an anti‑theft device, or an alcohol ignition interlock device, fitted to the vehicle.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)In this regulation —

hazard warning lights means the turn indicator lights on a vehicle when set to display regular flashes at the same time, and at the same rate, as each other.

[Regulation 188 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4597; SL 2020/184 r. 19; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 2Lights on animal‑drawn vehicles

189.Lights on animal‑drawn vehicles during hours of darkness or in hazardous weather conditions

A person must not drive an animal‑drawn vehicle during the hours of darkness, or in hazardous weather conditions causing reduced visibility, unless it is equipped with the appropriate lights and reflectors as prescribed by the Vehicle Standards and the lights are lit.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 189 amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4923; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 3Horns

190.Use of horns etc.

A person must not sound the horn or any other warning instrument in or on a vehicle, unless —

(a)it is necessary to use the horn, or warning device, to warn other road users or animals of the approach or position of the vehicle; or

(b)the horn, or warning device, is being used as part of an anti‑theft device, or an alcohol ignition interlock device, fitted to the vehicle.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 190 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4597; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 4Portable warning signs for heavy vehicles

191.Portable warning signs for disabled heavy vehicles

(1)In this regulation heavy vehicle means a vehicle of which the mass, together with any attached trailer and the total load carried (if any), exceeds 12 t.

(2)A person must not drive a heavy vehicle on a carriageway outside a built‑up area, or cause or permit a heavy vehicle to be so driven, unless there are carried on the vehicle 3 portable warning signs complying with AS 3790‑1992 (Portable Warning Triangles for Motor Vehicles) published by Standards Australia and the signs are in good order.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)Whenever a disabled heavy vehicle is stationary on a carriageway, outside a built‑up area, during the hours of darkness, the driver or person in charge of the vehicle must immediately place, and leave, on the carriageway 3 portable warning signs such as are mentioned in subregulation (2), one in advance of the vehicle, one to the rear of it and one beside it, on the side nearer to the centre of the carriageway.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)The portable warning signs placed on the carriageway in compliance with subregulation (3) are to be placed in the manner set out in subregulation (5) or (6A) as the case requires, and, wherever practicable, so that at least one sign is visible to an approaching driver, at a distance of not less than 200 m.

(5)Where the speed limit on a carriageway is lower than 80 km/h, the signs placed in advance and to the rear of the vehicle, in compliance with subregulation (3), are to be placed at a distance of between 50 m and 150 m from the vehicle, and the third sign is to be placed at the side of the vehicle in such a position as to give reasonable warning to drivers approaching from either direction.

(6A)Where the speed limit on a carriageway is 80 km/h or higher, the signs placed in advance and to the rear of the vehicle, in compliance with subregulation (3), are to be placed at a distance of between 200 m and 250 m from the vehicle, and the third sign is to be placed at the side of the vehicle in such a position as to give reasonable warning to drivers approaching from either direction.

(6B)For the purposes of determining whether subregulation (5) or (6A) applies, if the vehicle is in a speed zone that begins with a variable illuminated speed limit sign —

(a)if the carriageway is a freeway — subregulation (6A) is taken to apply; and

(b)in any other case — subregulation (5) is taken to apply.

(6)Nothing in this regulation affects —

(a)any duty imposed by these regulations to display lit lights on stationary vehicles; or

(b)public buses; or

(c)fire and emergency services vehicles.

[Regulation 191 amended: Gazette 6 Apr 2004 p. 1135; 22 Dec 2006 p. 5821; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6566; SL 2020/184 r. 20; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

192.Fallen loadings from heavy vehicles requiring signs

(1)In this regulation —

heavy vehicle means a vehicle of which the mass, together with any attached trailer and the total load carried (if any), exceeds 12 t.

(2)Where the load or any portion of the load that has fallen from a heavy vehicle is lying upon a carriageway, during the hours of darkness, and the driver is unable to —

(a)reload the fallen load on the vehicle; or

(b)remove the fallen load from the carriageway to such a position on the side of the road as will, as far as possible, reduce the danger to vehicles and pedestrians,

the driver must immediately place, and leave, on the carriageway 3 portable warning signs such as are mentioned in regulation 191(2) in the manner set out in subregulation (3) or (4A) as the case requires, and so that, where practicable, at least one sign, is visible to any approaching driver, at a distance of 200 m.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)Where the speed limit on a carriageway is lower than 80 km/h, the signs placed in advance and to the rear of the fallen load, in compliance with subregulation (2), are to be placed at a distance of between 50 m and 150 m from the edge of the fallen load, and the third sign is to be placed at the side of the fallen load in such a position as to give reasonable warning to drivers approaching from either direction.

(4A)Where the speed limit on a carriageway is 80 km/h or higher, the signs placed in advance and to the rear of the fallen load, in compliance with subregulation (2), are to be placed at a distance of between 200 m and 250 m from the edge of the fallen load, and the third sign is to be placed at the side of the fallen load in such a position as to give reasonable warning to drivers approaching from either direction.

(4B)For the purposes of determining whether subregulation (3) or (4A) applies, if the vehicle is in a speed zone that begins with a variable illuminated speed limit sign —

(a)if the carriageway is a freeway — subregulation (4A) is taken to apply; and

(b)in any other case — subregulation (3) is taken to apply.

(4)Subregulation (2) does not apply where the load of a heavy vehicle consists of rolls or bales of straw or hay, and straws of hay or similar light material may have blown, or dislodged, from the vehicle.

(5)A driver is not required to place the signs referred to in subregulation (2), where street lighting in the vicinity renders the fallen load clearly visible to a driver approaching from either direction, at a distance of 200 m.

[Regulation 192 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5821; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6566-7; SL 2020/184 r. 21; SL 2020/253 r. 21.]

193.Restriction on flashing warning lights

Subject to these regulations (and in particular regulations 188 and 289), the use, on a vehicle, of a light displaying intermittent flashes is prohibited.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Part 14Pedestrians

Division 1General

194.No pedestrians signs

A pedestrian must not travel past a “no pedestrians” sign.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

No pedestrians sign

(circle and slash in red)

[Regulation 194 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

195.Pedestrians on road with road access sign

Except in the event of an emergency or breakdown, or to assist a person apparently in need of assistance, a pedestrian must not be on a length of road to which a “road access” sign applies, if information on or with the sign indicates that pedestrians are not permitted beyond the sign.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Road access sign

End road access sign

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of the “road access” sign.

Note   The sign may indicate that it applies to different or additional vehicles or persons.

Note   The sign is usually used on a freeway.

[Regulation 195 amended: Gazette 13 Jul 2001 p. 3474; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4597‑8; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

196.Crossing carriageway — general

(1)When a pedestrian crosses a carriageway or portion of a carriageway, the pedestrian must —

(a)cross by the shortest safe route; and

(b)not stay on the carriageway longer than necessary to cross the carriageway safely.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)However, if the pedestrian is crossing the carriageway at an intersection with traffic‑control signals and a “pedestrians may cross diagonally” sign, the pedestrian may cross diagonally at the intersection.

Pedestrians may cross diagonally sign

(pedestrian in green)

Note   There is another permitted version of this sign.

[Regulation 196 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

197.Crossing at pedestrian lights

(1)This regulation applies to a pedestrian approaching or at an intersection, or another place on a carriageway, with traffic‑control signals that include pedestrian lights.

(2)If a traffic‑control signal shows a red pedestrian light and the pedestrian has not already started crossing the intersection or carriageway, the pedestrian must not start to cross until the pedestrian light changes to green.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Note   A traffic‑control signal (including a pedestrian light) generally only applies to a person if the signal or light faces the person.

(3)If, while the pedestrian is crossing the carriageway, the pedestrian light changes to flashing red or red, the pedestrian must not stay on the carriageway for longer than necessary to cross safely to the nearer (in the direction of travel of the pedestrian) of the following:

(a)a dividing strip or traffic island, forming part of the area set aside or used by pedestrians to cross the carriageway at the intersection or place (the safety area);

(b)the far side of the carriageway.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)If, under subregulation (3), a pedestrian crosses to “the safety area”, the pedestrian must remain in “the safety area” until the pedestrian lights change to green.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(5)Despite this regulation, if a pedestrian cannot operate the pedestrian lights from the safety area, that pedestrian may cross to the far side of the carriageway when —

(a)the traffic‑control signals display a circular green signal or a flashing circular yellow signal, or there is no circular red signal showing; and

(b)it is safe to do so.

Red pedestrian light

(pedestrian symbol in red)

Green pedestrian light

(pedestrian symbol in green)

[Regulation 197 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5821; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6567; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

198.Crossing carriageway with traffic‑control signals that do not include pedestrian lights

(1)This regulation applies to a pedestrian approaching or at an intersection, or another place on a carriageway, with traffic‑control signals that do not include pedestrian lights.

(2)If the traffic‑control signals show a circular red signal or a circular yellow signal and the pedestrian has not already started crossing the intersection or carriageway, the pedestrian must not start to cross until traffic‑control signals show a circular green signal or a flashing circular yellow signal, or there is no circular red signal showing.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)If, while the pedestrian is crossing the carriageway, the traffic‑control signals change to a circular red signal or a circular yellow signal, the pedestrian must not stay on the carriageway for longer than necessary to cross safely to the nearer (in the direction of travel of the pedestrian) of the following:

(a)a dividing strip or traffic island, forming part of the area set aside or used by pedestrians to cross the carriageway at the intersection or place (the safety area);

(b)the nearest side of the carriageway.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)If, under subregulation (3), a pedestrian crosses to “the safety area”, the pedestrian must remain in “the safety area” until the traffic‑control signals change to a circular green signal or a flashing circular yellow signal, or there is no circular red signal showing.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 198 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5821; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

199.Crossing carriageway on or near crossing for pedestrians

(1)A pedestrian must not cross a carriageway, or part of a carriageway, within 20 m of a children’s crossing, marked foot crossing or pedestrian crossing on the carriageway, except at the crossing or another crossing, unless the pedestrian is —

(a)crossing at an intersection with traffic‑control signals and a “pedestrians may cross diagonally” sign; or

(b)crossing in a shared zone; or

(c)crossing a carriageway, or a part of a carriageway, from which vehicles are excluded, either permanently or temporarily; or

(d)alighting from or boarding a public bus in a bus stop, bus zone or other authorised stopping place.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A pedestrian must not stay on a children’s crossing, marked foot crossing or pedestrian crossing on a carriageway for longer than necessary to cross the carriageway safely.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)Subregulation (2) does not apply to a person who is helping pedestrians cross a carriageway at a children’s crossing, marked foot crossing or pedestrian crossing.

Pedestrians may cross diagonally sign

(pedestrian in green)

Note   There is another permitted version of this sign.

[Regulation 199 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

200.Crossing level crossing

(1)A pedestrian must not cross a railway line at a level crossing unless —

(a)there is a path, bridge or other structure designed for the use of pedestrians at the crossing and the pedestrian uses it; or

(b)there is no path, bridge or other structure designed for the use of pedestrians at, or within 20 m of, the crossing.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A pedestrian must not cross a railway line at a level crossing if —

(a)warning lights (for example, twin alternating red lights, red pedestrian lights or rotating red lights) are illuminated or flashing, or warning bells are ringing; or

(b)a gate, boom or barrier at the crossing is closed, or is opening or closing; or

(c)a train is on or entering the crossing; or

(d)a train approaching the crossing can be seen from the crossing or is sounding a warning, and there would be a danger of the pedestrian being struck by the train if the pedestrian entered the crossing; or

(e)the crossing, or the carriageway beyond the crossing, is blocked.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example for subregulation (2)(e)

The crossing, or the carriageway beyond the crossing, may be blocked by congested traffic, a disabled vehicle, a collision between vehicles or between a vehicle and a pedestrian, or by stock on the carriageway.

(3)If a pedestrian has started to cross a railway line at a level crossing and —

(a)warning lights (for example, twin alternating red lights, red pedestrian lights or rotating red lights) are illuminated or start flashing, or warning bells start ringing; or

(b)a gate, boom or barrier at the crossing starts to close,

the pedestrian must get off the railway line without delay.

[Regulation 200 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5821; 4 Jun 2010 p. 2398; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

201.Pedestrians not to cause obstruction

(1)A person must not unreasonably obstruct or prevent the free passage of any other pedestrian or a vehicle upon a path or carriageway.

Modified penalty: 2 PU.

(2)In subregulation (1), a pedestrian does not unreasonably obstruct the path of another pedestrian only by travelling more slowly than other pedestrians.

[Regulation 201 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

202.Getting on or into moving vehicle

(1)A person must not alight from, or board, a moving vehicle, unless —

(a)the person is engaged in the door‑to‑door delivery or collection of goods, or in the collection of waste or garbage, and is required to get in or out of the vehicle, or on or off the vehicle, at frequent intervals; and

(b)the vehicle is not travelling at a speed over 5 km/h.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A person must not proceed from a path towards a vehicle for the purpose of boarding it, until it has stopped.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)This regulation does not apply to a person who is getting on or off a bicycle or animal.

[Regulation 202 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

203.Pedestrians travelling along carriageway (except in or on wheeled recreational device or toy)

(1)A pedestrian must not proceed along a carriageway where there is a footpath or nature strip adjacent to the carriageway and it is in a fit condition for use.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A pedestrian must not proceed along a carriageway abreast of more than one other pedestrian, except in a procession or parade authorised under a written law.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)A pedestrian travelling along a carriageway —

(a)must, where practicable, travel on the carriageway, or on the side of the carriageway, used by vehicles travelling in the opposite direction and keep as far to the right side of the carriageway as is practicable; and

(b)must not travel on the carriageway alongside more than one other pedestrian or vehicle travelling on the carriageway in the same direction as the pedestrian, unless the pedestrian is overtaking other pedestrians.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)Despite subregulation (3), where a vehicle approaches a pedestrian on a carriageway, on the same side as the pedestrian, then the pedestrian must, if possible, immediately move off the carriageway, and must not move back onto the carriageway, until the vehicle has passed him or her.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(5)Nothing in this regulation applies in respect of —

(a)a carriageway from which vehicles are for the time being excluded; or

(b)a carriageway that is a shared zone.

(6)In this regulation —

pedestrian does not include a person in or on a wheeled recreational device, a motorised scooter or wheeled toy.

[Regulation 203 amended: Gazette 25 Jan 2001 p. 593; 29 Dec 2006 p. 5924; 15 May 2018 p. 1532; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

204.Pedestrians on part of path designated for bicycles only

(1)A pedestrian must not be on a bicycle path, or the part of a separated footpath designated for the use of bicycles, unless the pedestrian —

(a)is crossing that path by the shortest safe route; and

(b)does not stay on that path for longer than necessary to cross the path safely.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)Despite subregulation (1), a pedestrian may be on a bicycle path, or the part of a separated footpath designated for the use of bicycles, if —

(a)the pedestrian is —

(i)in, or pushing, a wheelchair; or

(ii)on in‑line skates, rollerskates, a motorised scooter or a similar wheeled recreational device;

and

(b)there is no traffic sign, or information on or with a traffic sign, applying to the bicycle path or separated footpath that indicates that a pedestrian of a type described in paragraph (a) is not permitted to use that part of the path.

(3)A pedestrian who is crossing a bicycle path or the part of a separated footpath designated for the use of bicycles must keep out of the path of any cyclist, or any pedestrian who is permitted under subregulation (2) to be on that part of the path.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Bicycle path sign

End bicycle path sign

Separated footpath sign

End separated footpath sign

No bicycles sign

(circle and slash in red)

End no bicycles sign

(circle and slash in red)

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of these signs.

Note   The “separated footpath” sign may have the pedestrian symbol and the bicycle symbol reversed.

[Regulation 204 amended: Gazette 29 Dec 2006 p. 5924; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 2Persons travelling in or on wheeled recreational devices, motorised scooters and wheeled toys

[Heading amended: Gazette 29 Dec 2006 p. 5924.]

205.Games on roads

A person must not play any game on any part of a road.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 205 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

206.Wheeled recreational device, motorised scooters and toys prohibited on certain carriageways and at certain times

(1)A person must not travel in or on a wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy —

(a)on a carriageway with a dividing line or median strip; or

(b)on a one‑way carriageway with more than one marked lane; or

(c)on a carriageway with a speed limit exceeding 50 km/h.

Modified penalty:

(a)where the person is travelling on a carriageway with a speed limit exceeding 70 km/h — 10 PU

(b)in any other case — 1 PU

(1A)For the purposes of subregulation (1)(c) and the Modified penalty in subregulation (1), if the person is in a speed zone that begins with a variable illuminated speed limit sign, the reference to the speed limit is taken to be a reference to the speed limit applicable to the zone when the person enters the zone.

(2)A person must not travel in or on a wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or a wheeled toy, on a carriageway during the hours of darkness.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)A person travelling in or on a wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy on a road must not travel past a “no wheeled recreational devices, scooters or toys” sign.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)Subregulations (1) and (2) do not apply to a person who is crossing a carriageway in or on a wheeled recreational device or wheeled toy, if the person —

(a)crosses the carriageway by the shortest safe route; and

(b)does not stay on the carriageway longer than necessary to cross the carriageway safely.

No wheeled recreational devices, scooters or toys signs

206A

[Regulation 206 amended: Gazette 16 Nov 2001 p. 5990; 29 Dec 2006 p. 5922 and 5924‑5; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4598-9; SL 2020/184 r. 22; SL 2020/253 r. 22.]

207.Travelling in or on wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy on carriageway

A person travelling in or on a wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy on a carriageway —

(a)must keep as far to the left side of the carriageway as is practicable; and

(b)must not travel alongside more than one other pedestrian or vehicle travelling on the carriageway in the same direction as the person, unless the person is overtaking other pedestrians.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 207 amended: Gazette 29 Dec 2006 p. 5925; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

208.Travelling in or on wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy on footpath or shared path

A person travelling in or on a wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy on a footpath or shared path must —

(a)keep to the left of the footpath or shared path unless it is impracticable to do so; and

(b)give way to any pedestrian (except a person travelling in or on a wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy) who is on the footpath or shared path.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Shared path sign

End shared path sign

Note   There are a number of other permitted versions of these signs.

[Regulation 208 amended: Gazette 29 Dec 2006 p. 5925; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

209.Travelling on in‑line skates etc. on bicycle path or separated footpath

(1)A person travelling on in‑line skates, rollerskates, a motorised scooter or a similar wheeled recreational device, must not be on a part of a separated footpath designated for the use of pedestrians unless the person —

(a)is crossing the separated footpath by the shortest safe route; and

(b)does not stay on the separated footpath for longer than necessary to cross the separated footpath safely.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A person travelling on in‑line skates, rollerskates, a motorised scooter or a similar wheeled recreational device, on a bicycle path, or a part of a separated footpath designated for the use of bicycles, must keep out of the path of any cyclist or EPT rider.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 209 amended: Gazette 29 Dec 2006 p. 5925; 12 Apr 2013 p. 1534; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

209A.Protective helmets to be worn on motorised scooters

(1)In this regulation —

protective helmet means a helmet that is, or is of a standard or type that is, approved by the CEO, for the purposes of regulation 222, by notice in the Gazette.

(2)A person must not travel on a motorised scooter on a road or any path unless that person is wearing a protective helmet securely fastened on his or her head.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 209A inserted: Gazette 29 Dec 2006 p. 5923; amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

210.Towing of wheeled recreational devices, motorised scooters and toys

(1)A person travelling in or on a wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy must not attach himself or herself to, or permit himself or herself to be drawn by, any other vehicle.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A person must not travel in or on a wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy within 2 m of the rear of a motor vehicle, over a distance of more than 200 m.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)The driver of a vehicle must not permit a person travelling in or on a wheeled recreational device, motorised scooter or wheeled toy to attach himself or herself to, or be drawn by, the vehicle.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 210 amended: Gazette 29 Dec 2006 p. 5925; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

210A.Proper control of motorised scooters

A person must not on any road or path —

(a)travel on a motorised scooter while under the influence of alcohol, drugs or alcohol and drugs to such an extent as to be incapable of having proper control of the motorised scooter; or

(b)travel on a motorised scooter recklessly or without due care and attention.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 210A inserted: Gazette 29 Dec 2006 p. 5923; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 15Additional provisions for bicycle riders and electric personal transporters (EPTs)

[Heading amended: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1534.]

Division 1 — Bicycle riders

[Heading inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1534.]

211.Riding bicycles

The rider of a bicycle must —

(a)be astride the rider’s seat facing forward (except if the bicycle is not built to be ridden astride); and

(b)ride with at least one hand on the handlebars.

Modified penalty: 1 PU.

[Regulation 211 inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4599; amended: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2398; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6567; SL 2020/253 r. 23.]

212.Carrying people on bicycle

(1)A person must not use a bicycle to carry, at any one time, more persons than the number for which it is designed and equipped.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)The rider of a bicycle must not carry a child in a child carrying seat on a bicycle unless the rider —

(a)is at least 16 years of age; and

(b)has an uninterrupted view to the front of the bicycle from a normal seated position; and

(c)has unhindered access to all equipment, required by this Part, to be fitted to the bicycle.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)A passenger on a bicycle that is moving, or is stationary but not parked, must sit on a fitted seat designed for a passenger.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)The rider of a bicycle must not ride with a passenger unless the passenger complies with subregulation (3).

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 212 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4599-600; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

213.Riding in bicycle lane

Wherever a bicycle lane is provided as part of a carriageway, and is in a reasonable condition for use, a rider of a bicycle must use that portion of a carriageway and no other.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 213 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

214.Riding across a crossing

The rider of a bicycle riding across a carriageway, or part of a carriageway, on a children’s crossing, marked foot crossing or pedestrian crossing must —

(a)enter the crossing from the path connected to the crossing and not from the carriageway; and

(b)approach and ride on the crossing at a speed not exceeding 10 km/h; and

(c)keep to the left of the crossing unless it is impracticable to do so; and

(d)give way to any pedestrians on the crossing.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 214 inserted: SL 2020/253 r. 24.]

215A.Entering bicycle storage area on bicycle

(1)The rider of a bicycle approaching a bicycle storage area at an intersection that has traffic‑control signals showing a circular red signal or red arrow signal must not enter the bicycle storage area other than from a bicycle lane.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply if the bicycle storage area does not have a bicycle lane leading into it.

[Regulation 215A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4600; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

215B.Giving way while entering or in bicycle storage area on bicycle

(1)When entering a bicycle storage area, the rider of a bicycle must give way to —

(a)any vehicle that is in the area; and

(b)if the area is subject to a green or yellow traffic‑control signal — any motor vehicle that is entering or about to enter the area, unless the motor vehicle is turning in a direction that is subject to a red traffic arrow; and

(c)if the area forms part of a lane to which traffic‑control signal arrows apply — any motor vehicle that is entering or about to enter the area at a time when those arrows are green or yellow.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)The rider of a bicycle in a bicycle storage area that extends across more than one lane of a multi‑lane carriageway must, if the area is subject to a green or yellow traffic signal, give way to a motor vehicle that is in any lane other than the lane that the bicycle is directly in front of, unless the motor vehicle is turning in a direction that is subject to a red arrow signal.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 215B inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4600‑1; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

215.Riding on wrong part of separated footpath

The rider of a bicycle must not ride on a part of a separated footpath designated for the use of pedestrians only.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 215 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

216.Paths

(1)For the purposes of this regulation, a bicycle is abreast of another bicycle if any part of it is by the side of any part of the other.

(2)The rider of a bicycle on a path must give way to a pedestrian who is on, or is crossing, the path.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)The rider of a bicycle on a path must keep to the left of the path unless it is impracticable to do so.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)The rider of a bicycle on a path must not ride so that the bicycle is travelling abreast of any other bicycle on the path.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(5)Subregulations (3) and (4) do not prevent a rider from overtaking or passing other persons on the path.

[Regulation 216 inserted: Gazette 26 Apr 2016 p. 1277.]

217.Riding to left of oncoming bicycle riders on path

The rider of a bicycle riding on a path must keep to the left of any oncoming bicycle rider on the path.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 217 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

218.No bicycles signs and markings

(1)The rider of a bicycle must not ride on a length of carriageway or path to which a “no bicycles” sign, or a “no bicycles” road marking, applies.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A “no bicycles” sign, or a “no bicycles” road marking, applies to a length of carriageway or path beginning at the sign or marking and ending at the nearest of the following:

(a)a “bicycle path” sign or “bicycle path” road marking;

(b)a “bicycle lane” sign;

(c)a “separated footpath” sign or “separated footpath” road marking;

(d)a “shared path” sign;

(e)an “end no bicycles” sign;

(f)the next intersection.

No bicycles sign

(circle and slash in red)

Bicycle path sign

Bicycle lane sign

Separated footpath sign

Shared path sign

End no bicycles sign

(circle and slash in red)

[Regulation 218 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

219.Bicycle riders not to cause obstruction

(1)The rider of a bicycle must not unreasonably obstruct or prevent the free passage of a vehicle or pedestrian by moving into the path of the vehicle or a pedestrian.

(2)A person must not leave a bicycle in or upon a road so as to become an obstruction.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 219 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

220.Towing of bicycles

(1)The rider of a bicycle must not attach himself or herself to, or permit himself or herself to be drawn by, any other vehicle.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)The driver of a vehicle must not permit the rider of a bicycle to attach himself or herself to, or be drawn by, the vehicle.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 220 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

221.Riding too close behind motor vehicle

A person must not ride a bicycle within 2 m of the rear of a motor vehicle, over a distance of more than 200 m.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 221 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

222.Protective helmets to be worn

(1)In this regulation and in regulation 223 —

protective helmet means a helmet that is, or is of a standard or type that is, approved by the CEO, for the purposes of this regulation, by notice in the Government Gazette.

(2)Except as provided in this regulation, a person must not ride a bicycle on a road or any path unless —

(a)that person is wearing a protective helmet securely fastened on his or her head; and

(b)where any other person is being carried on that bicycle, that other person is wearing a protective helmet securely fastened on his or her head.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)Subregulation (2) does not apply to a person who —

(a)is a member of a religious or cultural group and who is wearing a headdress customarily worn by members of that group, if the wearing of that headdress makes it impractical for a person to wear a protective helmet; or

(b)has been exempted in writing by the CEO from wearing a protective helmet for medical reasons, and is complying with any terms and conditions of that exemption.

(4)The CEO may at any time, by notice in writing to the person, amend or revoke an exemption granted under subregulation (3)(b).

(5)Subregulation (2)(b) does not apply to a person riding a three or four‑wheeled bicycle who is carrying a paying passenger.

[Regulation 222 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4601; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

[222A.Deleted: Gazette 30 Aug 2011 p. 3517.]

223A.Passengers to wear protective helmets

(1)In this regulation —

protective helmet has the meaning given in regulation 222(1).

(2)A person must wear a protective helmet securely fastened on his or her head when being carried as a passenger on a bicycle.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[(3)deleted]

(4)Subregulation (2) does not apply to a person who is exempt from wearing a protective helmet under the provisions of regulation 222(3).

(5)Subregulation (2) does not apply to a paying passenger on a three or four‑wheeled bicycle.

[Regulation 223A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4601‑2; amended: Gazette 30 Aug 2011 p. 3517‑18.]

223.Riding with person on bicycle trailer

(1)The rider of a bicycle must not tow a bicycle trailer with a person in or on the bicycle trailer, unless —

(a)the rider is 16 years of age, or older; and

(b)the person in or on the bicycle trailer is under 10 years of age; and

(c)the bicycle trailer can safely carry the person; and

(d)the person in or on the bicycle trailer is wearing a protective helmet securely fitted and fastened on the person’s head.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)Subregulation (1)(d) does not apply to a person who is exempt from wearing a protective helmet under the provisions of regulation 222(3).

(3)In this regulation —

bicycle trailer means a vehicle that is built to be towed, or is towed, by a bicycle;

protective helmet has the meaning given in regulation 222(1).

[Regulation 223 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

224.Lights and other equipment on bicycles

(1)A person must not ride a bicycle during the hours of darkness, or in hazardous weather conditions causing reduced visibility, unless the bicycle, or the rider, displays —

(a)a flashing or steady white light that is clearly visible for at least 200 m from the front of the bicycle; and

(b)a flashing or steady red light that is clearly visible for at least 200 m from the rear of the bicycle; and

(c)a red reflector that is clearly visible for at least 50 m from the rear of the bicycle when light is projected onto it by a vehicle’s headlight on low‑beam.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2A)A person must not ride a bicycle during the hours of darkness, or in hazardous weather conditions causing reduced visibility, unless the bicycle has affixed, to each wheel, 2 yellow side reflectors complying with the requirements for reflectors in Australian Standard AS 1927‑1998 (Pedal Bicycle‑Safety Requirements) and Australian Standard AS 2142‑1978 (Specification for Reflectors for Pedal Bicycles).

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2B)A person must not ride a bicycle during the hours of darkness, or in hazardous weather conditions causing reduced visibility, unless the bicycle has affixed, to both sides of each pedal, yellow pedal reflectors complying with the requirements for reflectors in Australian Standard AS 2142‑1978 (Specification for Reflectors for Pedal Bicycles).

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2C)A person must not ride a bicycle that has affixed a reflector capable of reflecting red light in the forward direction.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A person must not ride a bicycle that does not have —

(a)at least one effective brake; and

(b)a bell, horn, or similar warning device, in working order.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 224 amended: Gazette 30 Aug 2011 p. 3518; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

225.Red bicycle crossing lights

Except as provided in regulation 43B, the rider of a bicycle on or approaching a carriageway with bicycle crossing lights must not cross or enter that carriageway if —

(a)a static red bicycle crossing light facing the rider is displayed; or

(b)a red bicycle crossing light facing the rider is flashing.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Example

Red bicycle crossing light

(bicycle symbol in red)

Green bicycle crossing light

(bicycle symbol in green)

[Regulation 225 inserted: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4168‑9; amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5821; SL 2020/253 r. 25.]

226.Stopping for yellow bicycle crossing light

(1)If the rider of a bicycle is approaching bicycle crossing lights showing a yellow bicycle crossing light and the rider can stop safely before reaching the bicycle crossing lights, the bicycle rider must stop before reaching the lights.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)If the rider of a bicycle has stopped before reaching bicycle crossing lights showing a yellow bicycle crossing light, and the lights change to red, the bicycle rider must not proceed until —

(a)the bicycle crossing lights change to green; or

(b)neither a red nor a yellow bicycle light is showing.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

Yellow bicycle crossing light

(bicycle symbol in yellow)

[Regulation 226 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5821; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

227.Proceeding when bicycle crossing lights change to yellow or red

(1)If bicycle crossing lights at an intersection change from green to yellow while a rider of a bicycle is in the intersection, the rider must finish crossing the intersection as soon as the rider can do so safely.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)If bicycle crossing lights at a place on a carriageway where the rider of a bicycle is crossing the carriageway change from green to yellow while the rider is on the carriageway, the rider must cross the carriageway as soon as the rider can do so safely.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)If bicycle crossing lights at an intersection change from green to red (static or flashing) while a rider of a bicycle is in the intersection, the rider must proceed to the nearest kerb, island or median strip in the direction of travel of the rider and not continue crossing the intersection until the bicycle crossing lights are green.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)If bicycle crossing lights at a place on a carriageway where the rider of a bicycle is crossing the carriageway change from green to red (static or flashing) while the rider is on the carriageway, the rider must proceed to the nearest kerb, island or median strip in the direction of travel of the rider and not continue crossing the carriageway until the bicycle crossing lights are green.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(5)Despite this regulation, if a rider cannot operate the bicycle crossing lights from a kerb, island or median strip, that rider may cross to the far side of the carriageway when —

(a)the traffic‑control signals display a circular green signal or a flashing circular yellow signal, or there is no circular red signal showing; and

(b)it is safe to do so.

[Regulation 227 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4169; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6567-8; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

228.Riding power assisted pedal cycle with power assistance engaged

A person under 16 years of age must not ride a power assisted pedal cycle with the power assistance engaged.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 228 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

229.Proper control of bicycles

A person must not on any road or path —

(a)ride a bicycle while under the influence of alcohol, drugs or alcohol and drugs to such an extent as to be incapable of having proper control of the bicycle; or

(b)ride a bicycle recklessly or without due care and attention.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 229 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4169; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 2 — Electric personal transporters (EPTs)

[Heading inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1535.]

Subdivision 1 — Preliminary

[Heading inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1535.]

230A.Terms used

In this Division —

commercial operator or operator means a person who hires out an EPT for reward or commercial gain;

protective helmet has the meaning given in regulation 222(1);

staff member, of a commercial operator, includes an employee, agent or contractor of the operator;

supervised tour has the meaning given in regulation 230L(1)(a).

[Regulation 230A inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1535.]

230B.EPTs and EPT use areas

(1)The Minister, by notice published in the Gazette, may —

(a)declare a standard, or type, of appropriate vehicle described in the notice as an electric personal transporter; and

(b)declare an area described in the notice as an electric personal transporter use area; and

(c)vary or revoke a previous notice under this regulation.

(2)In subregulation (1)(a) —

appropriate vehicle means a vehicle that has one or 2 wheels, that balances itself and is built to be powered primarily or entirely by an electric motor that forms part of the vehicle.

[Regulation 230B inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1535.]

Subdivision 2 — Provisions for EPT riders

[Heading inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1535.]

230C.EPTs to be ridden in EPT use areas only

A person must not ride an EPT other than in an EPT use area.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230C inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1535; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230D.Riders to be at least 12 years of age

A person must not ride an EPT unless the person is at least 12 years of age.

[Regulation 230D inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1535; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230E.EPT to be supplied and supervised by commercial operator

A person must not ride an EPT unless the person is riding with the permission of the commercial operator who has supplied the EPT to the person and —

(a)the person is taking part in a ride that —

(i)is part of; or

(ii)in preparation for,

a supervised tour that is provided by the operator and supervised by the operator or a staff member of the operator; or

(b)the person is being trained in the use of the EPT by the operator or a staff member of the operator.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230E inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1536; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230F.Riders to wear protective helmets

A person must not ride an EPT unless the person is wearing a protective helmet securely fastened on his or her head.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230F inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1536; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230G.Towing of EPTs prohibited

(1)The rider of an EPT must not attach himself or herself or the EPT to, or permit himself or herself or the EPT to be drawn by, or to draw, any other vehicle.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)The driver of a vehicle must not permit the rider of an EPT to attach himself or herself or the EPT to, or be drawn by, or to draw, the vehicle.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230G inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1536; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230H.Riding EPTs

(1)A person must not ride an EPT on a dividing strip or median strip.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A person riding an EPT must —

(a)keep to the left of any path the rider is on, except when the rider is overtaking; and

(b)give way to all pedestrians, including pedestrians riding wheeled recreational devices.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230H inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1536; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230I.No passengers or animals on EPTs

A person riding an EPT must not carry a passenger or animal on the EPT.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230I inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1537; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230J.EPT rider not to cause obstruction

(1)An EPT rider must not unreasonably obstruct or prevent the free passage of any other EPT rider, a pedestrian or a vehicle by moving into the path of a vehicle or a pedestrian.

(2)A person must not leave an EPT in or upon a road so as to become an obstruction.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230J inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1537; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Subdivision 3 — Provisions for commercial operators of EPTs

[Heading inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1537.]

230K.EPTs not to be able to exceed 10 km/h and to be fitted with warning devices

(1)A commercial operator must ensure that each EPT supplied to a rider by the operator cannot travel at a speed exceeding 10 km/h.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A commercial operator must ensure that each EPT supplied by the operator to a person is fitted with a bell, horn, or similar warning device, in working order.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230K inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1537; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230L.EPTs only to be for supervised tours or during training for supervised tours

(1)A commercial operator must ensure that a person does not ride an EPT supplied by the operator unless —

(a)the person is taking part in a ride that —

(i)is part of; or

(ii)in preparation for,

a tour (a supervised tour) that is provided by the operator and supervised by the operator or a staff member of the operator; or

(b)the person is being trained in the use of the EPT by the operator or a staff member of the operator, in accordance with subregulation (2).

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A commercial operator must not supply an EPT to a person to ride in a supervised tour provided by the operator unless the operator or a staff member of the operator has —

(a)trained the person in the use of the EPT, including getting on and off the EPT, stopping and starting the EPT, riding on slopes, managing intersections and various types of driving conditions; and

(b)assessed the person as competent to ride the EPT.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230L inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1537‑8; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230M.Supervised tours

(1)A commercial operator must ensure that —

(a)each supervised tour provided by the operator is undertaken only during daylight hours; and

(b)there is a minimum of one staff member to 10 EPT riders on each supervised tour provided by the operator.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A commercial operator must ensure that each EPT rider on each supervised tour provided by the operator is aware —

(a)of the provisions of Subdivision 2; and

(b)that a failure to comply with provisions of that Subdivision may expose the rider to a penalty under this Code.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)A commercial operator must ensure that each rider on a supervised tour provided by the operator is monitored for compliance with Subdivision 2.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 230M inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1538; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

230N.Records to be kept and supplied on demand

(1)A commercial operator must keep records about the following —

(a)any loss, damage, injury or death to people or property caused by the operator or a staff member in relation to the operation of an EPT supplied by the operator or by anyone else arising in relation to the use of an EPT;

(b)any failure by the operator or a staff member to comply with this Subdivision;

(c)any failure by a rider to comply with a provision of Subdivision 2.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)At the written request of the CEO, a commercial operator is to provide a report (in the form, if any, approved by the CEO) to the CEO, about all or any of the matters mentioned in subregulation (1).

[Regulation 230N inserted: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1538‑9; amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 16Persons travelling on or in a vehicle

Division 1Preliminary

230.Terms used

In this Part —

AS/NZS:1754‑1995 means Australian Standard AS/NZS:1754‑1995 (“Child restraint systems for use in motor vehicles”), or any subsequent version of, or amendments to, that standard, published jointly by Standards Australia and the Standards Association of New Zealand;

booster seat means —

(a)a booster seat or cushion that complies with the requirements of AS/NZS:1754‑1995; or

(b)a device designed to be a booster seat that is integrated into a vehicle by the vehicle’s manufacturer; or

(c)a booster seat or cushion that complies with the requirements of another standard approved by the CEO;

child restraint means a device that is fitted to a motor vehicle, that complies with the requirements of AS/NZS:1754‑1995, and includes —

(a)any device in AS/NZS:1754‑1995 that utilises as part of its design, a seatbelt; and

(b)a device designed to be a child restraint that is integrated into a vehicle by the vehicle’s manufacturer; and

(c)a device designed to be a child restraint that meets a standard other than AS/NZS:1754‑1995, and has been approved for use, in writing, by the CEO;

child safety harness means a harness that complies with —

(a)the requirements of AS/NZS:1754‑1995; or

(b)another standard approved by the CEO;

medical certificate means a certificate described in regulation 231;

medical practitioner means a person who is registered under the Health Practitioner Regulation National Law (Western Australia) in the medical profession;

produced, in relation to a medical certificate, means produced in accordance with regulation 231(3);

relevant time, in relation to an alleged offence, means the time at which the offence is alleged to have been committed;

seatbelt means a belt or similar device that is fitted to a motor vehicle and designed to restrain or limit the movement of a person who is seated in the vehicle and wearing the belt or device, if the vehicle suddenly accelerates or decelerates, but does not include a child restraint;

seating position, in relation to a motor vehicle, means —

(a)a position in that motor vehicle designed by the manufacturer to be sat upon; or

(b)a similar modification to the motor vehicle, approved by the CEO, that enables a person to be seated,

while the motor vehicle is being driven or ridden;

suitable child restraint means a child restraint that is appropriate to restrain the height and weight of the child that is to use it, according to the recommendations of either AS/NZS:1754‑1995, or the manufacturer’s recommendations;

suitable child safety harness means a child safety harness that is appropriate to restrain the height and weight of the child that is to use it, according to the recommendations of either AS/NZS:1754‑1995, or the manufacturer’s recommendations;

two‑up driver means a person accompanying a driver of a truck or bus on a journey, or part of a journey, who has been, is or intends to be sharing the task of driving the truck or bus during the journey.

[Regulation 230 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4170; 6 Apr 2004 p. 1135; 4 Jun 2010 p. 2399-401 and 2414; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5752‑3; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6568-9; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4923 and 4928; 28 Jun 2019 p. 2489.]

231.Medical certificate

(1)A medical certificate referred to in this Part must —

(a)be signed by a medical practitioner; and

(b)certify the relevant matter referred to in subregulation (2A); and

(c)be current at the time of the alleged offence.

(2A)The medical certificate must certify that —

(a)while driving or travelling in a motor vehicle —

(i)the person is unable for medical reasons to wear a seatbelt; or

(ii)because of the person’s size, build or other characteristic, it would be unreasonable to require the person to wear a seatbelt;

or

(b)while driving or travelling in a motor vehicle that has 2 or more rows of seats, the person is unable for medical reasons to sit anywhere except in the front row.

(2)A medical certificate is current for the purposes of subregulation (1)(c) if, at the relevant time —

(a)it is specified to have effect only for a specified period and that period has not expired; or

(b)it is endorsed with the words “permanent disability”; or

(c)in any other case, a period of not more than 2 years has expired from the day of its issue.

(3)A person must produce a medical certificate on demand to a police officer or, within a reasonable time after demand, to the CEO or to the officer in charge of any police station.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 231 amended: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2414-15; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5753; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928 and 4929; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 2 — Requirement to wear seatbelts, etc.

[Heading inserted: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2401.]

232.Driver to wear seatbelt

(1)The driver of a motor vehicle that is moving, or is stationary but not parked, must comply with this regulation if the driver’s seating position —

(a)is fitted with a seatbelt; or

(b)is required by a written law to be fitted with a seatbelt.

(2)The driver must wear a seatbelt properly adjusted and securely fastened unless the driver is —

(a)reversing the vehicle; or

(b)exempt from wearing a seatbelt under regulation 235.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 235A.

[Regulation 232 inserted: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2401-2.]

233.Wearing of seatbelts by passengers 16 years old or older

(1)A passenger in or on a motor vehicle that is moving, or that is stationary but not parked, must comply with subregulation (2) if the passenger —

(a)has reached 16 years of age; and

(b)is not exempt from wearing a seatbelt under regulation 235.

(2)The passenger —

(a)must occupy a seating position —

(i)that is fitted with a seatbelt; or

(ii)that is required by a written law to be fitted with a seatbelt;

and

(b)except as provided in subregulation (2A), must not occupy the same seating position as another passenger (whether or not the other passenger is exempt from wearing a seatbelt under regulation 235); and

(c)must wear the seatbelt properly adjusted and securely fastened.

Modified penalty: 11 PU.

(2A)Despite subregulation (2)(b), a passenger in a passenger transport vehicle, bus or tow truck may hold a child who is under 1 year of age in their lap if —

(a)there is no suitable child restraint available in the passenger transport vehicle, bus or tow truck for the child; and

(b)the passenger is not in the front row of seats if the passenger transport vehicle, bus or tow truck has 2 or more rows of seats.

(3)The driver of a motor vehicle (except a passenger transport vehicle) that is moving, or that is stationary but not parked, must ensure that each passenger in or on the vehicle who has reached 16 years of age complies with subregulation (2), unless the passenger is exempt from wearing a seatbelt under regulation 235.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 235A.

(4)For the purposes of this regulation, a child restraint is available in a motor vehicle if it is —

(a)fitted in the vehicle; and

(b)not occupied by someone else who is under 16 years of age.

Note:

Under regulation 284, regulation 233 does not apply to the driver of a bus.

[Regulation 233 inserted: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2402-3; amended: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5753; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; 15 May 2018 p. 1532‑3; 28 Jun 2019 p. 2489.]

234.Wearing of seatbelts by passengers under 16 years old

(1)The driver of a motor vehicle (except a motor cycle) that is moving, or is stationary but not parked, must ensure that this regulation is complied with for each passenger in or on the vehicle who is under 16 years of age.

Points and modified penalty: see regulation 235A.

(2)If the passenger is under 6 months of age, the passenger must be restrained in a properly fastened and adjusted rearward facing suitable child restraint.

(3)If the passenger has reached 6 months of age but is under 4 years of age, the passenger must be restrained in a properly fastened and adjusted —

(a)rearward facing suitable child restraint; or

(b)forward facing suitable child restraint that has an inbuilt harness.

(4)If the passenger has reached 4 years of age but is under 7 years of age, the passenger must —

(a)be restrained in a properly fastened and adjusted forward facing suitable child restraint that has an inbuilt harness; or

(b)be placed on a properly positioned booster seat and be restrained by either —

(i)a lap and sash type seatbelt that is properly adjusted and fastened; or

(ii)a lap only type seatbelt and (in relation to the upper body of the passenger) a child safety harness, each of which is properly adjusted and fastened.

(5)A passenger who is under 4 years of age must not be in the front row of a motor vehicle that has 2 or more rows of seats.

(6)A passenger who has reached 4 years of age but is under 7 years of age, must not be in the front row of a motor vehicle that has 2 or more rows of seats unless each other seat or unobstructed seating position in the row or rows behind the front row is either —

(a)occupied by a passenger who is under 7 years of age; or

(b)not suitable for the installation of a forward facing child restraint or a booster seat that would allow this regulation to be complied with for that passenger.

(7)If the passenger has reached 7 years of age but is under 16 years of age —

(a)the person must be restrained in a suitable child restraint that is properly adjusted and securely fastened; or

(b)the person —

(i)must occupy a seating position that is fitted with a seatbelt; and

(ii)must not occupy the same seating position as another passenger (whether or not the other passenger is exempt from wearing a seatbelt under regulation 235); and

(iii)must wear the seatbelt properly adjusted and securely fastened.

(8)Subregulations (2), (3), (4), (5) and (6) do not apply if the passenger is exempt from wearing a seatbelt under regulation 235.

(9)If a passenger cannot safely be restrained as required by subregulation (2) because of the passenger’s height or weight, the passenger must be restrained as if subregulation (3) applied to the passenger.

(10)If a passenger cannot safely be restrained as required by subregulation (3) or (9) because of the passenger’s height or weight, the passenger must be restrained as if subregulation (4) applied to the passenger.

(11)If a passenger cannot safely be restrained as required by subregulation (4) or (10) because of the passenger’s height or weight, the passenger must be restrained as if subregulation (7) applied to the passenger.

(12)In the case of a passenger sitting in a seating position that is fitted with a lap and sash type seatbelt, it is sufficient compliance with subregulation (4)(b)(i)or (7)(b)(iii), as the case may be, if, instead of using the sash part of the seatbelt, a child safety harness that is properly adjusted and fastened is used to restrain the upper body of the passenger.

(13)The driver of a passenger transport vehicle is exempt from subregulations (2), (3) and (4) in relation to a passenger if —

(a)there is no suitable child restraint available in the vehicle for the passenger; and

(b)the passenger is not in the front row of seats if the vehicle has 2 or more rows of seats.

(13A)If the exemption set out in subregulation (13) applies to a driver in relation to a passenger who has reached 1 year of age, the passenger must (unless exempt from wearing a seatbelt under regulation 235) wear a seatbelt that is properly adjusted and securely fastened to the best extent possible given the height and weight of the passenger.

(14)For the purposes of this regulation, a child restraint is available in a motor vehicle if it is —

(a)fitted in the vehicle; and

(b)not occupied by someone else who is under 16 years of age.

(15)For the purposes of this regulation, a child restraint that is properly fastened and adjusted —

(a)is forward facing if, once it restrains a passenger, his or her head is closer to the rear of the vehicle than his or her feet; or

(b)is rearward facing if, once it restrains a passenger, his or her feet are closer to the rear of the vehicle than his or her head.

Note:

Under regulation 284, regulation 234 does not apply to the driver of a bus.

[Regulation 234 inserted: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2403-6; amended: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5753‑4; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6569; 15 May 2018 p. 1533‑5; 28 Jun 2019 p. 2489.]

235.Specific exemptions from wearing seatbelts and defences

(1)A passenger who has reached 4 years of age but is under 7 years of age, is exempt from complying with regulation 234(4) if the passenger is —

(a)seated in a part of the motor vehicle designed primarily for the carriage of goods, in a seating position that is suitable for the passenger’s height and weight; and

(b)restrained by a seatbelt that is properly adjusted and securely fastened.

(2)In the case of a passenger sitting in a seating position that is fitted with a seatbelt, it is sufficient compliance with subregulation (1)(b) if, instead of using the seatbelt, a child safety harness that is properly adjusted and securely fastened is used to restrain the passenger.

(3)Subject to subregulation (4), a person in or on a motor vehicle has a defence to a charge under this Division relating to the wearing of a seatbelt if the person can show —

(a)the seating position that the person occupies is not fitted with a seatbelt; and

(b)there is no requirement under a written law for that seating position to be fitted with a seatbelt; and

(c)all passengers in the vehicle who are exempt from wearing a seatbelt or who have a defence to a charge under this Division are complying with subregulation (12).

(4)Subregulation (3) does not apply to a person charged under regulation 234(1) in relation to a passenger who is under 7 years of age.

(5)To avoid doubt, subregulation (3) does not authorise —

(a)more passengers in a motor vehicle than there are seating positions; or

(b)a passenger to whom regulation 234(5) or (6) applies to occupy a seat in the front row of seats in a vehicle that has 2 or more rows of seats.

(6)Except as provided in subregulation (6A), a person in or on a motor vehicle has a defence to a charge under this Division relating to the wearing of a seatbelt if the person can show —

(a)the person is engaged in the door‑to‑door delivery or collection of goods, or in the collection of waste or garbage, and is required to get in or out of the vehicle, or on or off the vehicle, at frequent intervals; and

(b)the vehicle does not exceed 25 km/h.

(6A)Subregulation (6) does not apply to a person charged under regulation 234(1) in relation to a passenger who is under 7 years of age.

(7)A person in or on a motor vehicle has a defence to a charge under this Division relating to —

(a)the wearing of a seatbelt; or

(b)the use of a child restraint or booster seat,

if the person who is not wearing the seatbelt or using the child restraint or booster seat has a medical certificate certifying a matter referred to in regulation 231(2A)(a) and, if required to do so, the person or driver produces the medical certificate.

(8A)The driver of a motor vehicle has a defence to a charge under regulation 234(6) if —

(a)the passenger referred to in the regulation has a medical certificate certifying the matter referred to in regulation 231(2A)(b); and

(b)if required to do so, the passenger or driver produces the medical certificate.

(8)A person is exempt from wearing a seatbelt during the hours of darkness if at the relevant time the person is driving a taxi that is carrying one or more passengers for reward.

(9)A person is exempt from wearing a seatbelt if he or she is providing or receiving medical treatment of an urgent and necessary nature while in or on a vehicle.

(10A)A person is exempt from using a child restraint or booster seat if he or she is receiving medical treatment of an urgent and necessary nature while in or on a vehicle.

(10)A passenger is exempt from wearing a seatbelt if, at the relevant time, the passenger was lawfully detained by an officer of a detention centre (as defined in the Young Offenders Act 1994 section 3) or an officer of a prison.

(11)If a truck or bus has a sleeper compartment, a two‑up driver of the truck or bus is exempt from wearing a seatbelt while he or she occupies the sleeper compartment for rest purposes.

(12)If a vehicle does not have seatbelts or child restraints fitted to all its passenger seating positions, a passenger who is exempt from wearing a seatbelt under this regulation, or has a defence to a charge under this Division, must not occupy a seating position that is fitted with a seatbelt or a child restraint if the result would be that a passenger who is not exempt from wearing a seatbelt under this regulation would be required to occupy a seating position that is not fitted with a seatbelt or a child restraint.

[Regulation 235 inserted: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2406-8; amended: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5754‑5; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6569; 15 May 2018 p. 1535‑6.]

235A.Penalties for seatbelt offences by driver

(1)In this regulation —

unrestrained, in relation to a passenger, means —

(a)a person who is not wearing a seatbelt or child restraint when required to do so under this Part; and

(b)a person who is under 16 years of age who —

(i)is not restrained in accordance with regulation 234, whether or not that person is wearing a child restraint or a child safety harness; or

(ii)is in a front seat, or in a seating position without a seatbelt, contrary to regulation 234.

(2)The following points and modified penalties apply for the offences in this Division that refer to this regulation for their penalty, where the driver is not wearing a properly adjusted and securely fastened seatbelt.

Table

Description

Points

Modified penalty

r. 232(2)

Driver not wearing a seatbelt (appropriately restrained passengers or no passengers) —

 

 

(a)during a holiday period

8

11 PU

(b)other than a holiday period

4

11 PU

r. 232(2) with r. 233(3) or 234(1)

Driver not wearing a seatbelt with one unrestrained passenger —

 

 

(a)during a holiday period

8

12 PU

(b)other than a holiday period

4

12 PU

r. 232(2) with r. 233(3) or 234(1)

Driver not wearing a seatbelt with 2 unrestrained passengers —

 

 

(a)during a holiday period

8

14 PU

(b)other than a holiday period

4

14 PU

r. 232(2) with r. 233(3) or 234(1)

Driver not wearing a seatbelt with 3 unrestrained passengers —

 

 

(a)during a holiday period

8

16 PU

(b)other than a holiday period

4

16 PU

r. 232(2) with r. 233(3) or 234(1)

Driver not wearing a seatbelt with 4 or more unrestrained passengers —

 

 

(a)during a holiday period

8

18 PU

(b)other than a holiday period

4

18 PU

(3)The following points and modified penalties apply for the offences in this Division that refer to this regulation for their penalty where the driver is wearing a properly adjusted and securely fastened seatbelt.

Table

Description

Points

Modified penalty

r. 233(3) or 234(1)

Driver wearing a seatbelt with one unrestrained passenger —

 

 

(a)during a holiday period

8

11 PU

(b)other than a holiday period

4

11 PU

r. 233(3) or 234(1)

Driver wearing a seatbelt with 2 unrestrained passengers —

 

 

(a)during a holiday period

8

12 PU

(b)other than a holiday period

4

12 PU

r. 233(3) or 234(1)

Driver wearing a seatbelt with 3 unrestrained passengers —

 

 

(a)during a holiday period

8

14 PU

(b)other than a holiday period

4

14 PU

r. 233(3) or 234(1)

Driver wearing a seatbelt with 4 or more unrestrained passengers —

 

 

(a)during a holiday period

8

16 PU

(b)other than a holiday period

4

16 PU

[Regulation 235A inserted: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2408-11; amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; 31 Oct 2014 p. 4181; 15 May 2018 p. 1536.]

[Division 3 (r. 236 and 237) deleted: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2401.]

Division 4Exceptions

[Heading amended: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2412.]

[238, 238A, 239.Deleted: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2412.]

240.Exemptions

(1)The CEO may, in writing, exempt —

(a)the driver of a particular vehicle and any passenger on that vehicle; or

(b)a particular vehicle or class of vehicles,

either generally, or for a specified time or purpose, from any of the provisions in Division 2.

(2)The CEO may at any time, and in the same manner, revoke an exemption given under subregulation (1).

[Regulation 240 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6756; 4 Jun 2010 p. 2412; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928.]

241.Police to consider safety of alleged offenders

(1)A police officer who apprehends a driver or a passenger committing an offence under regulation 234(1) may, having regard to the location in which the offence is alleged, and the safety of the apprehended person, give a direction authorising the apprehended person to travel to a specified destination, even though travelling to that destination would otherwise involve a further breach of the relevant regulation.

(2)A direction given under subregulation (1) may be subject to such reasonable conditions that the police officer considers necessary to ensure the safety of any person or persons affected by the direction.

(3)A person —

(a)travelling under the authority of a police officer under subregulation (1); and

(b)acting in accordance with the conditions (if any) imposed by the police officer when the direction was given,

does not commit a further offence against regulation 234(1) when travelling to the specified destination.

[Regulation 241 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6756; 4 Jun 2010 p. 2412; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4929.]

Division 5Other duties

242.Body or limbs protruding from vehicles

(1)A person while driving, or travelling in or on, a motor vehicle must not permit any part of his or her body or limbs —

(a)to be upon or in contact with any external part of the vehicle; or

(b)to extend or protrude beyond or through any external door, window or other opening of the vehicle; or

(c)to extend or protrude beyond or hang over any side or the front, rear or any other external portion of the vehicle.

Points: 1 (driver)Modified penalty: 1 PU (driver or passenger)

(2)A person must not drive a motor vehicle while a passenger has any part of his or her body or limbs —

(a)upon or in contact with any external part of the vehicle; or

(b)extending or protruding beyond or through any external door, window or other opening of the vehicle; or

(c)extending or protruding beyond or hanging over any side or the front, rear or any other external portion of the vehicle.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)This regulation does not prevent a driver from giving any signal authorised or prescribed by these regulations.

(4)This regulation does not apply to a person if —

(a)the person is driving a bus; or

(b)the person is riding, or a passenger on, a motor cycle; or

(c)the person is driving, or a passenger in or on, an emergency vehicle; or

(d)at the relevant time —

(i)the person was engaged in work that required the person to alight from and re‑enter the vehicle at frequent intervals; and

(ii)the vehicle was being driven at a speed not exceeding 25 km/h.

[Regulation 242 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5821; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

243.Opening doors and alighting from vehicles

A person must not —

(a)open, or leave open, a door of a vehicle; or

(b)alight from a vehicle onto a carriageway,

so as to endanger other persons using the road or impede the passage of traffic.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 243 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

244.Drivers and pillion passengers upon motor cycles to wear protective helmets

(1)In this regulation—

protective helmet means a helmet that is, or is of a standard or type that is, approved by the CEO, for the purposes of this regulation, by notice in the Gazette.

(2)A person must not drive a motor cycle unless —

(a)that person is wearing securely on his or her head a protective helmet; and

(b)where any other person is riding or being carried on the motor cycle, that other person is wearing a protective helmet securely on his or her head.

Points: 4Modified penalty: 11 PU

(3)Where any other person is riding or being carried on the motor cycle, that other person must wear a protective helmet securely on his or her head.

Modified penalty: 11 PU

(4)The provisions of subregulations (2) and (3) do not apply so as to require the wearing of a protective helmet by a person who has, for reasons relating to the person’s medical condition or for any other reason which the CEO considers sufficient, been exempted in writing by the CEO, on or before 30 November 2000, from that requirement.

(5)The CEO may at any time, by notice in writing to the person, amend or revoke an exemption given to a person under subregulation (4).

(6)An exemption given under this regulation —

(a)has effect from the time it is given until the expiry date ascribed to that exemption by the CEO and set out in the written exemption; and

(b)may be renewed for a specified period by the CEO.

[Regulation 244 amended: Gazette 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

245.Motor cycle rider to be properly seated

(1)The rider of a motor cycle that is moving, or the rider of a motor cycle that is stationary but not parked, must —

(a)sit astride the rider’s seat facing forwards; and

(b)ride with at least one hand on the handlebars, unless the motor cycle is stationary and, in the circumstances, it is safe to remove both hands from the handlebars; and

(c)if the motor cycle is moving — keep both feet on the footrests designed for use by the rider of the motor cycle,

while the motor cycle is on a road.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply to a person who is walking beside or pushing a motor cycle.

(3)Subregulation (1)(c) does not apply where the motor cycle is moving at less than 10 km/h and any of the following apply —

(a)the rider is manoeuvring the motor cycle in order to park the motor cycle;

(b)the motor cycle is decelerating to come to a stop;

(c)the motor cycle is accelerating from a stationary position.

[Regulation 245 inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4602‑3; amended: Gazette 15 May 2018 p. 1536; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

246A.Passengers on 2‑wheeled motor cycles

(1)In this regulation —

motor cycle does not include —

(a)a 2‑wheeled motor vehicle with a sidecar attached to it that is supported by a third wheel; or

(b)a motor vehicle with 3 wheels that is ridden in the same way as a motor vehicle with 2 wheels.

(2)A passenger on a motor cycle that is moving, or is stationary but not parked, must —

(a)sit astride the pillion seat facing forwards; and

(b)keep both feet on the footrests designed for use by a pillion passenger on the motor cycle,

while the motor cycle is on a road.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)The rider of a motor cycle must not ride with a passenger unless the passenger complies with subregulation (2).

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)The rider of a motor cycle must not ride on a road with more than one passenger.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(5)The rider of a motor cycle must not ride on a road with a passenger who has not attained 8 years of age.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 246A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4603‑4; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

246B.Passengers on trikes and motor cycles with sidecars

(1)In this regulation —

motor cycle means —

(a)a 2‑wheeled motor vehicle with a sidecar attached to it that is supported by a third wheel; or

(b)a motor vehicle with 3 wheels that is ridden in the same way as a motor vehicle with 2 wheels.

(2)The rider of a motor cycle must not ride on a road with more passengers in a sidecar, or on a seat designed for a passenger, than the sidecar, or seat, is designed to carry.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)A passenger must not ride on a road in a sidecar of a motor cycle unless the passenger is seated safely.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)The rider of a motor cycle must not ride on a road with a passenger in a sidecar unless the passenger complies with subregulation (3).

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(5)The rider of a motor cycle must not ride on a road with a passenger who has not attained 8 years of age unless the passenger is in a sidecar.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 246B inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4604‑5; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

246.Interfering with driver’s control of vehicle

A person must not act in any manner or occupy such a position on a moving vehicle as will occasion him or her —

(a)to interfere with or impede the driver in controlling the vehicle; or

(b)to prevent the driver and his or her signals from being clearly seen by the drivers of vehicles, or by pedestrians, in the immediate vicinity.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 246 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 17 Additional provisions for drivers of public buses etc., in bus lanes

[Heading amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4605.]

247A.Application of this Part

This Part applies to the driver of —

(a)a public bus when driving in a bus lane; and

(b)a vehicle other than a public bus, in the same way as it applies to the driver of a public bus if —

(i)the vehicle is being driven in a bus lane to which B lights apply; and

(ii)the driver is permitted to drive that vehicle in the bus lane under these regulations.

[Regulation 247A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4605; amended: Gazette 12 Apr 2013 p. 1539.]

247.Stopping for red B light

Subject to regulation 249, the driver of a public bus approaching or at B lights showing a red B light must stop —

(a)if there is a stop line at or near the B lights — as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the stop line; or

(b)if there is no stop line at or near the B lights — as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the nearest or only B lights.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

[Regulation 247 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

248.Stopping for yellow B light

Subject to regulation 249, the driver of a public bus approaching or at B lights showing a yellow B light must stop —

(a)if there is a stop line at or near the B lights and the driver can stop safely before reaching the stop line — as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the stop line; or

(b)if there is no stop line at or near the B lights and the driver can stop safely before reaching the B lights — as near as practicable to, but before reaching, the nearest or only B lights.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 248 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5822; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

249.Exception to stopping for red or yellow B light

Despite regulations 247 and 248, the driver of a public bus approaching or at B lights showing a red or yellow B light does not have to stop if the traffic‑control signal is also showing a white arrow, and the driver is turning in the direction indicated by the arrow.

250.Proceeding after stopping for red or yellow B light

The driver of a public bus who stops for B lights showing a red or yellow B light must not proceed until —

(a)a white B light is showing; or

(b)no B light is showing and traffic‑control signals at or near the B lights are showing a circular green light.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

[Regulation 250 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

251.Proceeding when traffic‑control signal shows circular red light and white B light or white traffic arrow is showing

(1)The driver of a public bus approaching or at a white B light at or near traffic‑control signals showing a circular red light may proceed straight ahead, or turn, despite the circular red light.

(2)The driver of a public bus approaching or at a traffic‑control signal showing both a white arrow and a circular red light may turn in the direction indicated by the arrow, despite the circular red light.

White B light

252.Proceeding when white B light or white arrow is no longer showing

(1)This regulation applies to —

(a)the driver of a public bus at an intersection with B lights showing a white B light who has stopped after the stop line, or nearest or only B lights, at the intersection; or

(b)the driver of a public bus at an intersection with traffic‑control signals showing a white arrow, who is turning in the direction indicated by the arrow and has stopped after the stop line, or the nearest or only arrow, at the intersection.

Example

The driver of a public bus may stop after the stop line at an intersection with B lights showing a white B light, and not proceed through the intersection, because the intersection, or a carriageway beyond the intersection, is blocked by traffic.

(2)If the B lights or arrows displayed by the traffic‑control signals change to yellow or red, or turn off, while the driver of a public bus is stopped and the driver has not entered the intersection, the driver must not proceed until —

(a)a white B light is showing; or

(b)there is no B light showing, and traffic‑control signals at or near the B lights are showing a circular green light; or

(c)if the driver is turning at the intersection — the traffic‑control signals are showing a white arrow, which indicates the direction in which the driver is turning.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 3 PU

(3)If the B lights or arrows displayed by the traffic‑control signals change to yellow or red, or turn off, while the driver is stopped and the driver has entered the intersection, the driver must leave the intersection as soon as the driver can do so safely.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 252 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 18Miscellaneous provisions

Division 1Miscellaneous provisions for drivers

253.Driving on paths

(1)A person must not drive a vehicle on a path.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply to —

(a)a person driving on a part of a path indicated by information on or with a traffic sign as a part where vehicles may drive; or

(b)a physically disabled person in a wheelchair or in a motorised wheelchair; or

(c)a person pushing a perambulator or wheelchair; or

(d)a person wheeling a bicycle, if the person is completely dismounted from the bicycle; or

(e)a person riding a bicycle on a path; or

[(f)deleted]

(g)a person driving a vehicle across the path by the shortest route to enter or leave a driveway or lane; or

(h)a person riding a bicycle, or a motor cycle, that is a postal vehicle, if —

(i)the path is not more than 100 m from the next delivery point; and

(ii)the person takes adequate precautions to avoid colliding with, endangering or obstructing any person or vehicle on the path; and

(iii)the person is riding the bicycle or motor cycle at a speed not exceeding 10 km/h;

or

(i)a police officer driving a special purpose vehicle; or

(j)a person who is 12 years of age or older riding an EPT —

(i)that cannot travel at a speed exceeding 10 km/h; and

(ii)in an EPT use area.

(3)Subregulation (2) only applies to a wheelchair if —

(a)the unladen mass of the wheelchair is not over 110 kg; and

(b)the wheelchair is not travelling over 10 km/h; and

(c)because of the driver’s physical condition, the driver has a reasonable need to use a wheelchair.

(4)The driver of a vehicle driving on a path (except the rider of a bicycle) must give way to all other persons, and to animals, on the path.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(5)This regulation does not apply to the rider of an animal riding the animal on a footpath.

[Regulation 253 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5822; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4541; 12 Apr 2013 p. 1539; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4929; 26 Apr 2016 p. 1278; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

254.Driving on nature strip

(1)A person must not drive a vehicle on a nature strip adjacent to a length of carriageway in a built‑up area, unless the driver is —

(a)entering or leaving, by the shortest practicable route, an area on the nature strip indicated by information on or with a road sign as an area where vehicles may drive; or

(b)driving on a part of the nature strip indicated by information on or with a road sign as a part where vehicles may drive; or

(c)driving on the nature strip to enter or leave, by the shortest practicable route, an area adjacent to a carriageway and there is not a part of the nature strip indicated by information on or with a road sign as a part where vehicles may drive; or

(d)driving a postal vehicle; or

(e)riding a bicycle or animal; or

(f)driving a ride‑on lawnmower that is cutting grass on the nature strip; or

(g)driving a motorised wheelchair; or

(h)permitted to drive, or park on the nature strip under a local law.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A driver driving on a nature strip (except the rider of an animal) must give way to all other persons, and to animals, on the nature strip.

Penalty:

(a)if offence committed by the driver of a motor vehicle other than a ride‑on lawn mower or motorised wheelchair —

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU;

(b)otherwise —

Modified penalty: 2 PU.

[Regulation 254 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5819; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

255.Creating excessive noise

A person must not drive a vehicle, in such a manner as to create or cause any undue or excessive noise, or smoke.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

Example

Causing the wheels of the driver’s vehicle to lose traction and spin on the road surface may make unnecessary noise or smoke.

[Regulation 255 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

256.Putting glass etc. on roads

(1)A person must not throw, drop, place or leave or cause or allow to be thrown, dropped, placed or left upon a road any bottle, glass, nail, tack, wire, can, destructive or injurious material or any substance or thing likely to —

(a)endanger any person, animal or vehicle; or

(b)obstruct the path of other drivers or pedestrians, or damage a vehicle or anything else (for example, the road surface).

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)A person who throws, drops, places or leaves anything, or who causes or allows anything to be thrown, dropped, placed or left upon a road, in contravention of subregulation (1), must, as soon as practicable thereafter, remove it or cause it to be removed.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(3)A person removing a wrecked or damaged vehicle from a road must remove any glass or other destructive, injurious or dangerous substance or thing that has fallen upon the road from that vehicle.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)Where the load or any portion of the load of a vehicle falls from the vehicle to the carriageway, the driver of that vehicle must immediately —

(a)reload the fallen object on the vehicle; or

(b)remove the fallen object from the carriageway to such a position on the side of the road as will, as far as possible, reduce the danger to vehicles and pedestrians.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

(5)Subregulation (4) does not apply to straws of hay or similar light material which may blow, or dislodge, from a vehicle loaded with rolls or bales of hay or straw, if that material does not cause a danger or hazard to any person or property.

[Regulation 256 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

257.Securing of loads

(1)A person must not drive a vehicle that is carrying a load, if the load is placed on the vehicle in a way that —

(a)makes the vehicle unstable or otherwise unsafe; or

(b)it projects from the vehicle in a way that is likely to injure a person, obstruct the path of other drivers or pedestrians, or damage a vehicle or anything else (for example, the road surface).

Modified penalty: 3 PU

(2)A person must not drive a vehicle that is carrying a load, unless the load is restrained on the vehicle so that the load, or any portion of it, is unlikely —

(a)to fall from the vehicle; or

(b)to become dislodged from the place on the vehicle where it is restrained.

Modified penalty: 3 PU

(3)A person must not drive a vehicle that is carrying a load, unless the load is restrained on the vehicle by a system appropriate to the load.

Modified penalty: 3 PU

(4)A person must not drive a vehicle that is carrying a load comprising grain, unless that grain is fully covered or enclosed.

Modified penalty: 3 PU

(5)In this regulation and regulation 258 —

to become dislodged from, in relation to a vehicle, does not include to fall from the vehicle.

[Regulation 257 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5822; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

258.Evidentiary provisions relating to securing of loads

(1)In any proceedings for an offence against regulation 257(1), evidence that the load on the vehicle driven by the accused was not restrained on the vehicle by a system that complies with the performance standards is evidence that the load was placed on the vehicle in a way that made the vehicle unstable or otherwise unsafe.

(2)In any proceedings for an offence against regulation 257(2)(a), evidence that the load on the vehicle driven by the accused was not restrained on the vehicle by a system that complies with the performance standards is evidence that the load was not restrained on the vehicle so that the load, or any portion of it, was unlikely to fall from the vehicle.

(3)In any proceedings for an offence against regulation 257(2)(a), evidence that the load, or any portion of it, on the vehicle driven by the accused fell from the vehicle, is evidence that the load was not restrained on the vehicle so that the load, or any portion of it, was unlikely to fall from the vehicle and, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, is proof of that fact.

(4)In any proceedings for an offence against regulation 257(2)(b), evidence that the load on the vehicle driven by the accused was not restrained on the vehicle by a system that complies with the performance standards is evidence that the load was not restrained on the vehicle so that the load, or any portion of it, was unlikely to become dislodged from the place on the vehicle where it was restrained.

(5)In any proceedings for an offence against regulation 257(2)(b), evidence that the load, or any portion of it, became dislodged from the place on the vehicle where it was restrained, is evidence that the load was not restrained on the vehicle so that the load, or any portion of it, was unlikely to become dislodged from the place on the vehicle where it was restrained and, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, is proof of that fact.

(6)In any proceedings for an offence against regulation 257(3), evidence that the load on the vehicle driven by the accused was not restrained on the vehicle by a system that complies with the performance standards is evidence that the load was not restrained on the vehicle by a system appropriate to the load.

(7)In this regulation —

g means the force equivalent to the force generated by the rate of acceleration due to gravity, which is to be taken to be 9.81 m/s2 for the purposes of the performance standards;

performance standards, in relation to a system by means of which a load is restrained on a vehicle, means the requirement that the system is capable of restraining the load on the vehicle despite being subjected to each of the following forces separately:

(a)0.8 g deceleration in a forward direction;

(b)0.5 g deceleration in a backward direction;

(c)0.5 g acceleration in a lateral direction;

(d)0.2 g acceleration, relative to the load, in a vertical direction.

[Regulation 258 amended: Gazette 29 Feb 2008 p. 697.]

259.Selling papers and cars, hitch‑hiking etc.

(1)A person must not, while on a carriageway or median strip —

(a)solicit contributions, employment or a ride from an occupant of a vehicle; or

(b)offer a newspaper, periodical or magazine for sale, to the occupant of a vehicle.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A driver, or a passenger, in or on a vehicle must not buy or offer to buy an article or service from a person who is on a carriageway.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)A person must not park a vehicle on any portion of a road if the vehicle is exposed for sale.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 259 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4606; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

260.Vehicles etc. to have wheels

A person must not drive or draw a vehicle, tractor, machine, implement or other thing or cause it to be driven or drawn, unless —

(a)provision is made for its movement on wheels and no part of it, other than the wheels, comes into contact with the road; and

(b)its wheels or tyres, as the case may be, conform with the requirements of the Vehicle Standards.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 260 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

261.Driving backwards

A person must not drive a vehicle in reverse —

(a)unless he or she can do so with safety; or

(b)for a greater distance than is reasonable, having regard to the circumstances.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 261 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5822; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

[262.Deleted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4606.]

263.Drivers to have uninterrupted and undistracted views etc.

(1)A person must not drive a vehicle, unless —

(a)he or she is in such a position behind the steering wheel that he or she has full control over the vehicle; and

(b)he or she can obtain a full and uninterrupted view of the road and any traffic ahead and on each side of him or her; and

(c)he or she can obtain, in a rear‑vision mirror or mirrors attached to the vehicle, a clear reflected view of every overtaking vehicle.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)For the purposes of subregulation (1), a driver is not able to obtain a full and uninterrupted view of the road and any traffic ahead and on each side of him or her if the vehicle has —

(a)a mascot, toy or similar article attached to the windshield, or to the rear or other window of the vehicle; or

(b)a mascot, toy or similar article attached to the interior of the vehicle in such a position as to obstruct or be likely to obstruct the vision, or to distract or to be likely to distract the attention, of a person while driving the vehicle.

(3)A driver must not drive a motor vehicle if a person or an animal is in the driver’s lap.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 263 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2006 p. 5822; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4606; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

264A.Dogs etc. on motor cycles

(1)The rider of a motor cycle must not ride with an animal on the part of the motor cycle between the rider and the handlebars, or in another position that interferes with the rider’s ability to control the motor cycle or to have a clear view of the carriageway.

Points: 1Modified penalty: 2 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply to a person who rides with an animal on the part of the motor cycle between the rider and the handlebars for a distance of not more 500 m on a road for the purposes of a farming activity that the person is carrying out, provided it is safe to do so.

[Regulation 264A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4606‑7; amended: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5755; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

264.Use of visual display units etc. in vehicle

(1)A driver must not drive a vehicle that has a television receiver or visual display unit in or on the vehicle operating while the vehicle is moving, or is stationary but not parked, if any part of the image on the screen —

(a)is visible to the driver from the normal driving position; or

(b)is likely to distract another driver.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 6 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply to a driver if —

(a)the driver is driving a public bus and the visual display unit is, or displays, a destination sign or other bus sign; or

(ba)the driver is the rider of a motor cycle or bicycle and the visual display unit is, or is part of, a driver’s aid and is attached to the rider’s arm (but not hand‑held); or

(b)the visual display unit is, or is part of, a driver’s aid and either —

(i)is an integrated part of the vehicle design; or

(ii)is secured in a mounting affixed to the vehicle while being used;

or

(c)the driver is driving a taxi and the visual display unit is displaying work‑related information; or

(d)the visual display unit is the display unit of a video recording device or a mobile data terminal fitted to a police or emergency vehicle.

(3)For the purposes of subregulation (2)(b)(ii), a visual display unit is secured in a mounting affixed to the vehicle if, and only if —

(a)the mounting is commercially designed and manufactured for that purpose; and

(b)the unit is secured in the mounting, and the mounting is affixed to the vehicle, in the manner intended by the manufacturer.

Examples of driver’s aids

1Closed‑circuit television security cameras.

2Dispatch systems.

3Navigational or intelligent highway and vehicle system equipment.

4Rearview screens.

5Ticket‑issuing machines.

6Vehicle monitoring devices.

[Regulation 264 amended: Gazette 4 Jun 2010 p. 2413; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5755‑6; 31 Dec 2013 p. 6569; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; SL 2020/253 r. 26.]

265.Use of mobile phones

(1)In this regulation —

audio call does not include an email, text message, video call, video message or other similar communication;

body, in relation to a mobile phone, means the part of the phone that contains the majority of the phone’s mechanisms;

held includes held by, or resting on, any part of the driver’s body, but does not include held in a pocket of the driver’s clothing or in a pouch worn by the driver;

mobile phone does not include a CB radio or any other two‑way radio;

use, in relation to a mobile phone, includes any of the following actions by the driver of a vehicle —

(a)hold the phone;

(b)enter or place anything into the phone, or send or look at anything that is in the phone;

(c)turn the phone on or off;

(d)operate any other function of the phone.

(1A)For the purposes of this regulation, a driver is in a restricted area if —

(a)the driver is in a school zone during a school zone period indicated on the “school zone” sign at the beginning of the zone; or

(b)the driver is on a freeway; or

(c)the speed limit applicable to the area or zone that the driver is in is 80km/h or more (or, in the case of a speed zone that begins with a variable illuminated speed limit sign, the speed limit applicable to the zone when the driver enters the zone is 80km/h or more); or

(d)the driver is approaching or passing a stationary incident response vehicle (as defined in regulation 137A(1)), unless the driver —

(i)is on a two‑way carriageway; and

(ii)the incident response vehicle is on the side of the carriageway used by vehicular traffic travelling in the opposite direction to the driver.

(2)A driver of a vehicle must not use a mobile phone while the vehicle is moving, or is stationary but not parked, unless —

(a)the phone is being used to make or receive an audio call and the body of the phone —

(i)is secured in a mounting affixed to the vehicle while being so used; or

(ii)is not secured in a mounting affixed to the vehicle and is not being held by the driver, and the use of the phone does not require the driver, at any time while using it, to press any thing on the body of the phone or otherwise to manipulate any part of the body of the phone;

or

(b)the visual display of the phone is being used as a driver’s aid in accordance with regulation 264 and the use of the phone does not require the driver, at any time while using it, to press any thing on the body of the phone or otherwise to manipulate any part of the body of the phone; or

(c)all of the following apply —

(i)the vehicle is an on‑demand vehicle (as defined in the Transport (Road Passenger Services) Act 2018 section 4(1));

(ii)the phone is being used to accept, confirm the start of or cancel a booking for the vehicle to be used in the provision of an on‑demand passenger transport service (as defined in the Transport (Road Passenger Services) Act 2018 section 5(1));

(iii)the body of the phone is secured in a mounting affixed to the vehicle while being so used;

(iv)the driver is not in a restricted area;

(v)in the circumstances it is safe for the driver to use the phone as referred to in subparagraph (ii).

Points:

(a)during a holiday period: 6;

(b)other than during a holiday period: 3.

Modified penalty: 10 PU.

(2A)For an offence against subregulation (2), the points and modified penalty set out at the foot of this subregulation apply in the following cases instead of the points and modified penalty set out at the foot of subregulation (2) —

(a)the phone is being used —

(i)to create, send or read a text message or email; or

(ii)to make or receive a video call; or

(iii)to create, send or view a video message; or

(iv)to take or view a photo; or

(v)to make or view a video;

(b)any other case in which the phone is being used otherwise than to make or receive an audio call.

Points:

(a)during a holiday period: 8;

(b)other than during a holiday period: 4.

Modified penalty: 20 PU.

(3)For the purposes of this regulation, a driver does not use a mobile phone if —

(a)a text message, video message, email or similar communication is received automatically by the phone; and

(b)on and after the receipt, the communication itself, rather than any indication that the communication has been received, does not become automatically visible on the screen of the phone.

[Regulation 265 inserted: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5756‑7; amended: Gazette 4 Apr 2014 p. 886; 9 Sep 2014 p. 3247; SL 2020/87 r. 4; SL 2020/184 r. 23.]

[266.Deleted: Gazette 10 Jun 2008 p. 2467.]

Division 2Provisions for people in charge of animals

267.Leading animals

(1)A person riding an animal must not lead more than one other animal.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)A person must not lead an animal, while riding in a motor vehicle, or more than 2 animals while riding in any other vehicle that is not an animal.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)A person must not drive a vehicle (that is not an animal) if an animal tethered to that vehicle is walking or running behind or alongside the vehicle when the vehicle is moving.

Points: 3 (if the vehicle is a motor vehicle)

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 267 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

268.Rider of animal on footpath or nature strip to give way to pedestrians

The rider of an animal must give way to any pedestrian on a footpath or nature strip.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 268 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

269.Riding animal alongside more than one other rider

(1)The rider of an animal must not ride on a carriageway that is not a multi‑lane carriageway alongside more than one other rider, unless the rider is overtaking the other riders or droving stock.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)The rider of an animal must not ride in a marked lane alongside more than one other rider in the marked lane, unless the rider is overtaking the other riders or droving stock.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(3)If the rider of an animal is riding on a carriageway that is not a multi‑lane carriageway alongside another rider, or in a marked lane alongside another rider in the marked lane, the rider must not ride more than 1.5 m from the other rider.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 269 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

270.Proper control of animals

A person must not on any road or place to which the public is permitted, whether on payment of a fee or otherwise, to have access —

(a)drive or ride an animal while under the influence of alcohol, drugs or alcohol and drugs to such an extent as to be incapable of having proper control of the animal;

(b)drive or ride an animal recklessly or without due care and attention.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 270 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 3Directions by police and authorised persons

271.Authorised person to be declared

(1)For the purposes of this Division, the Commissioner of Police may declare a person or class of persons to be an authorised person.

(2)Notice of a declaration under subregulation (1) is to be published in the Gazette.

[Regulation 271 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4170 1.]

272.Obedience to police or authorised persons

(1)Every pedestrian and driver must obey the signal by hand or the reasonable oral direction given by a police officer or —

(a)an authorised person, if the signal or direction given by him or her is given for the purpose of ensuring the safety, or facilitating the movement, of traffic or persons at or near the scene of an incident resulting in a dangerous situation; or

(b)an authorised person, if the signal or direction given by him or her is given for the purpose of facilitating the movement of a fire engine or other emergency vehicle; or

(c)an authorised person, if the signal given by him or her is given for the purpose of facilitating the movement of an ambulance that is an emergency vehicle; or

(d)an authorised person, if the signal or direction given by that person is given —

(i)for the purpose of facilitating the movement of an oversize vehicle being escorted by a licenced pilot vehicle driver; and

(ii)while the authorised person is wearing reflective apparel of a type approved by the Commissioner of Police by notice published in the Gazette,

notwithstanding that the signal or oral direction given by any of them appears to require the pedestrian or driver to act in contravention of these regulations.

Points: 3 (driver)

Modified penalty: 2 PU (driver or pedestrian)

(2)It is a defence to any prosecution notice of a breach of these regulations that the accused was, at the time of the alleged offence, acting in conformity with a signal or direction given under subregulation (1).

[Regulation 272 amended: Gazette 11 Jan 2002 p. 51; 30 Jul 2004 p. 3107; 29 Feb 2008 p. 697; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4929; 15 Nov 2016 p. 5062; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

273.Directions by police

(1)Where a police officer regulating traffic gives a signal to stop, then —

(a)a driver approaching the person giving the signal, from the direction towards which the palm of that person’s hand is facing, must stop the vehicle at a stop line, or the edge of the intersection, or at a reasonable distance from that person, and must not drive forward, until given the signal to proceed; and

(b)a pedestrian must not cross the carriageway —

(i)at an intersection, except in the direction in which vehicular traffic is then permitted to proceed; or

(ii)at a place, other than at an intersection, until given the signal, or otherwise directed, to proceed.

Points: 3 (driver)

Modified penalty: 2 PU (driver or pedestrian)

(2)For the purposes of this regulation —

(a)a signal to stop may be given with either hand, with the upper arm horizontal, the forearm and fingers pointing upwards, and the open palm of the hand facing the traffic that is required to stop; and

(b)a signal to proceed may be given by extending the arm and fingers horizontally to the body, and then moving the forearm in the direction, with the palm facing towards the direction in which the traffic is required to proceed.

(3)Notwithstanding the provisions of subregulation (1), a driver approaching a police officer from that person’s front or rear must, where no signal is given, stop the vehicle and not drive forward, until given the signal to proceed.

Points: 3Modified penalty: 2 PU

(4)A person must not obstruct any police officer who is exercising any of the powers vested in him or her, or performing any of the duties imposed upon him or her, under the provisions of the Act or these regulations.

Modified penalty: 2 PU

[Regulation 273 amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4929; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 4Unattended and unauthorised vehicles and stock on roads

[274.Deleted: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4923.]

275.Unattended stock on roads

(1)A person in charge of stock must not —

(a)allow it to stray onto a road; or

(b)having taken stock onto a road, allow it to remain there unattended, or inadequately attended.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)It is a defence to a complaint under subregulation (1), of allowing stock to stray onto a road, that all reasonable precautions were taken to prevent the stock from straying onto the road.

(3)Any stock that is straying on, unattended on or obstructing any portion of, a road, may be seized by a police officer or an officer of the local government of the district and placed in a public pound.

[Regulation 275 amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4929; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

276.Restrictions on driving of stock

A person must not drive stock along or across a road unless the person —

(a)takes all reasonable precautions to warn approaching traffic of the presence of the stock; and

(b)arranges the driving of the stock at such times, and in such numbers, and establishes such control of the stock on the road, as is likely to prevent it causing unreasonable delay to the passage of other traffic.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 276 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

277.Permit for driving of stock

(1)A person must not drive a herd of cattle or a flock of sheep into, or along, a road or public place within a town without first having obtained the permission in writing to do so, from the CEO.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)The CEO may, when granting permission for the purposes of this regulation, restrict the operation of the permit to such times and places as the CEO thinks fit.

(3)A person must not drive animals in respect of which a permit has been issued under this regulation, except in accordance with the terms and conditions of the permit.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 277 amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 5Towing

278.Towing a vehicle, trailer etc.

(1)A person must not drive a vehicle that is towing another vehicle, on a road, unless —

(a)the space between the 2 vehicles does not exceed 4 m or, where either vehicle is a motor cycle, 2.5 m; and

(b)any rope, chain or wire used for the purposes of the tow, that is longer than 2 m, has a flag or other similar object attached to it, so as to render it clearly visible to traffic approaching the tow, laterally; and

(c)a competent and qualified person is in charge of the towed vehicle, to control it, while on tow, and that person can, in fact, control it; and

(d)it is safe to do so.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)The provisions of subregulation (1) do not apply where a vehicle is being towed in such a manner that some of its wheels are not on the ground; and the CEO may, by a permit in writing, waive the requirements of that subregulation, subject to such conditions as the CEO may impose and, in that event, a person must not cause the vehicle to be towed, except in conformity with those conditions.

(3)A person must not drive a vehicle towing a trailer or an articulated vehicle, while a person is in or upon that trailer or the towed part of the articulated vehicle.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)A person must not ride —

(a)in or upon a trailer or the towed part of an articulated vehicle, while it is being towed; or

(b)in a towed vehicle, unless all wheels of that vehicle are on the ground.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(5)Subregulations (3) and (4)(a) do not apply —

(a)to the driver of a vehicle towing a trailer or a person riding on a trailer where the trailer is actually engaged in work at the site of road construction or maintenance; or

(b)to the driver of an articulated vehicle or a person riding on the towed part of an articulated vehicle where the rear part of that vehicle is being manually steered; or

(c)to the driver of a vehicle towing a trailer or a person riding on a trailer where the trailer —

(i)is equipped with fire fighting appliances; and

(ii)is being used for the control of fire or for fire management purposes; and

(iii)complies with the Vehicle Standards in relation to mudguards,

and does not exceed 15 km/h.

(6)Subregulation (3) does not apply to the driver of a vehicle towing a trailer (if the trailer is designed to carry passengers) or to the driver of an articulated vehicle (if the towed part of that articulated vehicle is designed to carry passengers) where —

(a)a licence relating to that trailer, or that towed part of an articulated vehicle, has been endorsed by the CEO to the effect that it is suitable for the carriage of passengers; and

(b)the towing speed does not exceed 80 km/h; and

(c)the vehicle is being driven in accordance with any conditions imposed upon the licence relating to the trailer or towed part of that articulated vehicle.

(7)Subregulation (4)(a) does not apply to a person riding in or upon —

(a)a trailer, if the trailer is designed to carry passengers; or

(b)the towed part of an articulated vehicle, if the towed part of that articulated vehicle is designed to carry passengers.

(8)If there is an inconsistency between a provision of this regulation and a provision of the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 Part 13, the latter prevails to the extent of the inconsistency.

[Regulation 278 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4171; 7 Dec 2010 p. 6100; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4924 and 4928; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

279.Towed vehicles, trailers etc.

(1)Subject to subregulation (2), a person must not drive —

(a)an articulated vehicle to which any other vehicle is attached; or

(b)any vehicle to which more than one other vehicle is directly or indirectly attached,

except in conformity with such special or general directions as the Commissioner of Main Roads may from time to time give, either directly or by notice in the Government Gazette.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)Subregulation (1) does not apply in relation to the towing of —

(a)an articulated vehicle in accordance with the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 Part 12; or

(b)a vehicle in accordance with the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 Part 13.

[Regulation 279 amended: Gazette 1 Nov 2002 p. 5398; 7 Dec 2010 p. 6100; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4924; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Part 19Exemptions, specific local and transitional provisions

Division 1Exemptions

280.Exemption for drivers of emergency vehicles (police officers)

(1)A provision of these regulations does not apply to the driver of an emergency vehicle being used for official duties by a police officer if —

(a)in the circumstances —

(i)the driver is taking reasonable care; and

(ii)it is reasonable that the provision should not apply;

and

(b)the vehicle is moving; and

(c)in the case of a motor vehicle, it is displaying a blue or red flashing light or sounding an alarm.

(2)Subregulation (1)(c) does not apply to the driver if, in the circumstances, it is reasonable —

(a)not to display the light or sound the alarm; or

(b)for the vehicle not to be fitted or equipped with a blue or red flashing light or an alarm.

[Regulation 280 amended: Gazette 22 Dec 2015 p. 5131.]

281.Exemption for drivers of emergency vehicles (other)

A provision of these regulations does not apply to the driver of an emergency vehicle that is not being used for official duties by a police officer if —

(a)in the circumstances —

(i)the driver is taking reasonable care; and

(ii)it is reasonable that the provision should not apply;

and

(b)the vehicle is a motor vehicle that is moving and the vehicle is displaying a blue or red flashing light or sounding an alarm.

282A.Exemption for drivers of vehicles used in police driver training

A provision of these regulations does not apply to the driver of a vehicle being used for police driver training by a police officer if —

(a)the police driver training is approved by the Commissioner of Police; and

(b)the vehicle being used for the police driver training —

(i)is a motor cycle; or

(ii)is built or modified for the purpose of police driver training and displays markings of a type approved by the Commissioner of Police for that purpose;

and

(c)in the circumstances —

(i)the driver is taking reasonable care; and

(ii)it is reasonable that the provision should not apply.

[Regulation 282A inserted: Gazette 26 Nov 2010 p. 5959; amended: Gazette 31 Dec 2019 p. 4686.]

282.Stopping and parking exemption for emergency vehicles, police vehicles and authorised persons

(1)A provision of Part 12 does not apply to the driver of an emergency vehicle or a vehicle being used for routine official duties by a police officer if, in the circumstances —

(a)the driver is taking reasonable care; and

(b)it is reasonable that the provision should not apply.

(2)A provision of Part 12 does not apply to a driver who is an authorised person driving a vehicle in the course of his or her duty as an authorised person if, in the circumstances —

(a)the driver is taking reasonable care; and

(b)it is reasonable that the provision should not apply.

(3)Regulation 132 and 133, and the provisions of Part 12, do not apply to a driver who is driving a vehicle collecting household waste for or on behalf of a local government if, in the circumstances —

(a)the driver is taking reasonable care; and

(b)it is reasonable that the provision should not apply.

[Regulation 282 amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4929.]

283.Exemption for police and emergency workers on foot or on patrol

(1)A provision in Part 14 does not apply to a police officer or an emergency worker acting in the course of his or her duty if, in the circumstances —

(a)the police officer or emergency worker is taking reasonable care; and

(b)it is reasonable that the provision should not apply.

(2)In this regulation —

emergency worker means —

(a)member of a fire brigade; or

(b)an ambulance officer; or

(c)a member of the State Emergency Services; or

(d)a person specified as an emergency worker, for the purposes of these regulations, by the CEO.

[Regulation 283 amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928 and 4929.]

284.General exemptions from seatbelt provisions

(1)Part 16 does not apply to —

(a)a police officer when the driving is in the course of his or her duty and in urgent circumstances; or

(b)the drivers and passengers of fire fighting vehicles when engaged in fire fighting activity;

(c)an ambulance officer or any person providing medical assistance to a person;

(d)a person who, or class of persons that, has been exempted in writing by the CEO from the application of the Part, and is complying with any terms and conditions of that exemption.

(2)Part 16 Divisions 2 and 4 do not apply to a passenger of a police officer or to a police officer conveying a passenger if, in the officer’s opinion, the wearing of a seatbelt would be inappropriate (for example, when the passenger is in lawful custody, or when the safety of the officer may be compromised).

(3)Regulations 233 and 234 do not apply to the driver of a bus.

(4)Regulation 234 does not apply to the following:

(a)the driver of, or passengers on or in, an emergency vehicle;

(b)the driver of, or passengers on or in, a vehicle while it is being used solely, or principally, for agricultural purposes or farming activities.

[Regulation 284 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4171; 9 Mar 2007 p. 849; 4 Jun 2010 p. 2413 and 2414-15; 19 Nov 2010 p. 5757; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4924, 4928 and 4929.]

285.Exemption for road workers etc.

(1)A provision set out in the Table to subregulation (2) does not apply to a person at the site of, and engaged in, roadworks if, in the circumstances —

(a)it is not practicable for the person to comply with the provision; and

(b)sufficient warning of the roadworks has been given to other road users.

(2)Subregulation (1) applies to the provisions set out in the Table to this subregulation.

Table

Regulation 12 (Minimum speeds on freeways)

Part 4 (Turns) Division 1 (Left turns at intersections) and Division 2 (Right turns (except hook turns) at intersections)

Part 7 (Giving way), except —

*regulation 50 (Stopping and giving way at a stop sign or stop line at an intersection without traffic‑control signals)

*regulation 51 (Stopping and giving way at a stop sign or stop line at other places)

*regulation 52 (Giving way at a give way sign or give way line at an intersection)

*regulation 53 (Giving way at a give way sign at a bridge or length of narrow carriageway)

*regulation 54 (Giving way at a give way sign or give way line at other places)

Part 8 (Traffic signs and road markings), except —

*regulation 84 (Clearance and low clearance signs — to the extent that a vehicle passes a sign, but not so as to allow an oversize vehicle to attempt to pass under the object that is the subject of the sign)

*regulation 85 (Load limit signs)

Part 11 (Keeping to the left), except —

*regulation 121 (No overtaking unless safe to do so)

*regulation 124 (Keeping a safe distance when overtaking)

Part 12 (Restrictions on stopping and parking)

Regulation 190 (Using horns and similar warning devices)

Part 14 (Regulations for pedestrians), except regulation 201(1) (which is about unreasonably causing a traffic hazard by moving into the path of an approaching vehicle or pedestrian)

Regulation 232(2) (Driver to wear seatbelt)

Regulation 233(2) (Passenger to wear seatbelt)

Regulation 233(3) (Driver to ensure that 16 year old passenger wears seatbelt)

Regulation 234(3) (Driver to ensure that under 16 year old passenger is restrained)

Regulation 242 (Body or limbs protruding from vehicles)

Regulation 253 (Driving on paths)

Regulation 254 (Driving on a nature strip)

Regulation 261 (Driving backwards)

Regulation 263(1)(b) (which requires a driver to have a clear view of the surrounding road and traffic)

Regulation 278(1)(a) and (b) (which are about the space between vehicles and the visibility of the tow line when towing a vehicle)

(3)Regulation 11 (Speed limits generally) does not apply to a driver driving a motor vehicle and engaged in speed zoning activities authorised by the Minister.

(4)In this regulation —

roadworks means —

(a)construction or maintenance of a road (including a level crossing); or

(b)road cleaning; or

(c)installation or maintenance work authorised under another law of this jurisdiction on, above or below a road; or

(d)installation or maintenance of a traffic‑control signal, road sign, traffic‑related item or traffic monitoring device; or

(e)a traffic survey authorised under another written law; or

(f)a road surface survey test.

[Regulation 285 amended: Gazette 8 Feb 2008 p. 319; 29 Feb 2008 p. 698; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4607; 4 Jun 2010 p. 2414.]

285A.Exemption for operators of speed measuring equipment

(1)A provision set out in the Table to subregulation (2) does not apply to a person certified by the Commissioner of Police (or a delegate) as being competent to use speed measuring equipment when that person is acting in the course of his or her duty relating to the operation of approved speed measuring equipment if, in the circumstances —

(a)the person is taking reasonable care; and

(b)it is reasonable that the provision should not apply.

(2)Subregulation (1) applies to the provisions set out in the Table to this subregulation.

Table

*regulation 76 (driving in an emergency stopping lane)

*regulation 76A (driving in an emergency stopping bay)

*regulation 119 (driving on or across a median strip, painted island, etc.)

*regulation 140 (stopping in a no stopping area)

*regulation 141 (stopping or parking in a no parking area)

*regulation 142 (stopping on a carriageway with a yellow edge line)

*regulation 149 (stopping on a freeway)

*regulation 150 (stopping in an emergency stopping bay, emergency stopping lane or red X lane)

*regulation 161 (stopping on a bridge or in a tunnel, etc.)

*regulation 165 (stopping on a path, median strip, nature strip or traffic island)

*regulation 166(1) (obstructing access to and from a path)

*regulation 173 (parking for longer than indicated)

*regulation 175 (parking where fees are payable)

*regulation 176(1), but only as it relates to subregulations (2), (6) and (7) (parallel parking on a carriageway)

*regulation 177 (parallel parking in a median strip parking area)

*regulation 178 (angle parking)

*regulation 179 (parking in parking bays)

*regulation 181 (failing to secure a motor vehicle)

*regulation 195 (pedestrians on a road with a road access sign)

*regulation 204 (pedestrians on part of a path designated for bicycles only)

*regulation 253 (driving on paths)

*regulation 254 (driving on a nature strip)

[Regulation 285A inserted: Gazette 11 Dec 2002 p. 5789‑90; amended: SL 2020/184 r. 24.]

285B.Exemption for operators of “red light” cameras

(1)A provision set out in the Table to subregulation (2) does not apply to a person employed by the Commissioner of Police (or a delegate) to install, clean, maintain or operate cameras placed at intersections to record vehicles that do not comply with traffic lights, when that person is acting in the course of his or her employment if, in the circumstances —

(a)the person is taking reasonable care; and

(b)it is reasonable that the provision should not apply.

(2)Subregulation (1) applies to the provisions set out in the Table to this subregulation.

Table

*regulation 140 (stopping in a no stopping area)

*regulation 141 (stopping or parking in a no parking area)

*regulation 142 (stopping on a carriageway with a yellow edge line)

*regulation 143(2) (stopping within 20 m of an intersection with traffic‑control signals)

*regulation 158 (stopping in a shared zone)

*regulation 165 (stopping on a path, median strip, nature strip or traffic island)

*regulation 173 (parking for longer than indicated)

*regulation 175 (parking where fees are payable)

*regulation 181(2) (failing to secure a motor vehicle)

*regulation 201 (person obstructing pedestrians or vehicles on a path)

*regulation 204 (pedestrians on part of a path designated for bicycles only)

*regulation 253 (driving on paths)

*regulation 254 (driving on a nature strip)

[Regulation 285B inserted: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4171‑2.]

286.Exemption for oversize vehicles

A provision set out in the Table to this regulation does not apply to the driver of an oversize vehicle, or the driver of a vehicle escorting or piloting an oversize vehicle, if —

(a)it is not practicable for the driver to comply with the provision; and

(b)the driver is taking reasonable care; and

(c)the driver is complying with any other relevant law of this jurisdiction relating to oversize vehicles, including the conditions of any permit or authority issued in relation to the oversize vehicle.

Table

*Part 7 (Giving way), except —

*regulation 50 (Stopping and giving way at a stop sign or stop line at an intersection without traffic‑control signals)

*regulation 51 (Stopping and giving way at a stop sign or stop line at other places)

*regulation 52 (Giving way at a give way sign or give way line at an intersection)

*regulation 53 (Giving way at a give way sign at a bridge or length of narrow carriageway)

*regulation 54 (Giving way at a give way sign or give way line at other places)

*Part 8 (Traffic signs and road markings), except —

*regulation 85 (Load limit signs)

*regulation 92(3) (which is about entering a roundabout from the right marked lane or line of traffic)

*regulation 97 (Obeying arrows marked on the surface of a marked lane in a roundabout)

*Part 11 (Keeping to the left), except —

*regulation 121 (No overtaking unless safe to do so)

*regulation 124 (Keeping a safe distance when overtaking)

*Part 12 (Restrictions on stopping and parking)

*regulation 242 (Body or limbs protruding from vehicles)

*regulation 253 (Driving on paths)

*regulation 254 (Driving on a nature strip)

*regulation 261 (Driving backwards)

*regulation 263(1)(b) (which requires a driver to have a clear view of the surrounding road and traffic)

[Regulation 286 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6756; 25 Jan 2001 p. 593.]

287.Exemption for tow truck drivers

(1)It is a defence to the prosecution of the driver of a tow truck for an offence against a provision set out in the Table to this regulation if, at the time of the offence —

(a)the driver is engaged in loading, or connecting to, a vehicle set out in subregulation (2); and

(b)the driver is unable to comply with the provision; and

(c)the tow truck is displaying a flashing light; and

(d)the driver is acting safely.

Table

*Part 6 (Traffic‑control signals (traffic lights and twin alternating red lights))

*Part 7 (Giving way) Division 1 (Places with a stop sign, stop line, give way sign or give way line applying to the driver)

*Part 8 (Traffic signs and road markings)

*Part 9 (Roundabouts)

*Part 11 (Keeping to the left, etc)

*Part 12 (Restrictions on stopping and parking)

*regulation 253 (Driving on paths)

*regulation 254 (Driving on a nature strip)

(2)This regulation applies to towing the following vehicles —

(a)a vehicle at the scene of an accident;

(b)a disabled vehicle;

(c)a vehicle unsafely or unlawfully parked that the driver is authorised to tow away under another law of this jurisdiction.

288A.Exemption for motor break‑down service vehicles

(1)In this regulation —

motor break‑down service vehicle does not include a tow truck.

(2)A provision set out in the Table to this regulation does not apply to the driver of a motor break‑down service vehicle if —

(a)the driver is engaged in repairing a disabled vehicle or is assisting a person to gain access to a vehicle in which the person has locked the vehicle access key; and

(b)it is not practicable for the driver to comply with the provision; and

(c)the motor break‑down service vehicle is displaying a yellow flashing light; and

(d)the driver is acting safely.

Table

*

regulation 119 (Driving on median strips, painted islands, etc.)

*

regulation 127 (Moving from one marked lane to another marked lane across a continuous line separating the lanes)

*

regulation 254 (Driving on a nature strip)

[Regulation 288A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4607‑8; amended: Gazette 31 Dec 2013 p. 6570.]

288B.Exemption for Main Roads incident response service

The regulations specified in the Table do not apply to a person providing an incident response service on behalf of the Commissioner of Main Roads.

Table

r. 12

r. 20 to 22

r. 24 to 27

r. 30 to 33

r. 41

r. 44

r. 69 to 73

r. 76 to 78

r. 92

r. 96 and 97

r. 99

r. 108

r. 111 to 113

r. 115 to 120

r. 125 to 127

r. 129

r. 131 to 137

r. 140 to 162

r. 164 to 181

r. 194 to 201

r. 203 and 204

r. 253 and 254

[Regulation 288B inserted: Gazette 31 Oct 2017 p. 5465.]

288.Exemption for postal vehicles

A provision set out in the Table to this regulation does not apply to the driver of a postal vehicle.

Table

*regulation 151 (Stopping in a loading zone)

*regulation 152 (Stopping in a truck zone)

*regulation 154(1) (which relates to stopping in a taxi zone)

*regulation 155 (Stopping in a mail zone)

*regulation 159 (Double parking)

*regulation 161 (Stopping on a bridge or in a tunnel, etc.)

*regulation 162 (Restriction on stopping vehicle on crests, curves, etc.)

*regulation 166 (Obstructing access to and from a path, driveway, etc.)

289.Exemption for certain vehicles displaying flashing warning lights

(1)Regulation 193 (prohibiting the use, on a vehicle, of a light displaying intermittent flashes) does not extend to —

(a)the use of a light displaying intermittent flashes of a colour or colours approved by the CEO, upon —

(i)a vehicle when conveying a police officer on official duty or when that vehicle is stationary at any place connected with the official duty; or

(ii)any other type of vehicle approved by the CEO and used in conformity with any conditions that may be imposed by the CEO;

or

(b)the use, of a light displaying intermittent red flashes (or flashes of another colour or colours approved by the CEO), upon an emergency vehicle; or

(c)the use of a light displaying intermittent yellow flashes (or flashes of another colour or colours approved by the CEO), upon —

(i)an emergency vehicle, or a vehicle conveying a person who is authorised by the Director General under section 49 of the Transport Co‑ordination Act 1966; and

(ii)a special purpose vehicle occupying a hazardous position on a road, while stationary or manoeuvring at a speed not exceeding 20 km/h; and

(iii)a vehicle engaged in road construction or road maintenance as described in regulation 285(4); and

(iv)a pilot or escort vehicle travelling in front of or behind a vehicle or convoy of vehicles to which an order or permit as defined in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Act 2012 section 32 relates; and

(iva)a vehicle or vehicle combination to which an order or permit as defined in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Act 2012 section 32 relates and which requires those lights; and

(v)a pilot or escort vehicle travelling in front of or behind an agricultural machine, a towed agricultural implement, or a convoy of such vehicles; and

(va)an agricultural machine that is required or permitted by the Vehicle Standards to be fitted with such a light; and

(vb)a towed agricultural implement or a vehicle towing an agricultural implement, that is required or permitted by the Vehicle Standards to be fitted with such a light; and

(vi)a vehicle operated by the Botanic Gardens and Parks Authority, being used for official duties in King’s Park (being all that land from time to time known as Reserve No. 1720, classified as of Class A); and

(vii)a vehicle that is being used to drive stock along or across a road, where the flashing lights comply with the equipment described in the Vehicle Standards; and

(viii)a fire control vehicle (other than that of a fire brigade) which is used to control or extinguish fires (when that vehicle does not conform to the Vehicle Standards in relation to lighting equipment), if the signalling devices comply with the equipment described in those regulations and the vehicle is travelling to or from a fire or a fire control exercise; and

(ix)a motor vehicle that is used solely or principally for the carriage of children to and from school, equipped to carry more than 8 adult persons (including the driver), when in the process of picking up or setting down school children; and

(x)a motor break‑down service vehicle when the driver is attending a disabled vehicle;

or

(d)the use, upon a taxi, for the purpose of indicating that the driver is under attack or otherwise in distress, of flashing white lights fitted within the illuminated sign of the taxi; or

(e)the use, upon a bicycle, of a flashing light, in compliance with, or if permitted by, regulation 224.

(2)This regulation does not prohibit the use of flashing signalling devices —

(a)in accordance with Part 5 or Part 13 Division 1; or

(ab)that are a part of an alarm system; or

(b)on military vehicles operated by the Defence Forces of the Commonwealth.

(3)In this regulation agricultural implement and agricultural machine have the same meanings as they have in the Road Traffic (Vehicles) Regulations 2014 regulation 3.

[Regulation 289 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6756‑7; 1 Nov 2002 p. 5398; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4608; 12 Apr 2013 p. 1539; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4925 and 4928.]

Division 2Specific local provisions

290.Processions and public meetings

(1)A person must not, without the authority in writing of the Commissioner of Police, conduct a procession or parade; and a person must not take part in a procession or parade that has not been authorised pursuant to this regulation.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)The Commissioner of Police must authorise the conduct, subject to such safety conditions, and lawful requirements and limitations as the Commissioner of Police sees fit to impose, of a lawful procession or parade unless the Commissioner of Police is satisfied that the procession or parade will —

(a)give rise to an obstruction that is too great or too prolonged, in the circumstances; or

(b)occasion damage to a road; or

(c)create a public nuisance.

(3)A person must not conduct a procession or parade, or take part in a procession or parade that is, to his or her knowledge, conducted contrary to any condition or limitation imposed under subregulation (2).

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4)A person must not hold or address any public meeting upon any roads or address any public meeting assembled on any road, from any public or private place adjacent thereto, unless the person has first obtained written permission from the Commissioner of Police and except on the date and at the time and place specified in such written permission.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 290 amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

291.Temporary closure of or restriction on use of roads

Where, for the more effective control of traffic, it appears to the Commissioner of Main Roads to be necessary or expedient to close a road or portion of a road or to set apart a road or portion of a road for traffic travelling in one direction or for traffic of a particular class, the Commissioner of Main Roads may, with the authority of the Minister and after giving such notice as the Minister may direct, do any of those things by means of road signs.

292.Restrictions on traffic in pedestrian mall

A person must not drive a vehicle in a pedestrian mall unless that vehicle is —

(a)a public bus; or

(b)an emergency vehicle; or

(c)a special purpose vehicle; or

(d)being used by a medical practitioner in the practice of his or her profession; or

(e)a taxi conveying a lodger to or from premises to which access is ordinarily gained from the pedestrian mall and in respect of which a hotel licence is in force under the Liquor Control Act 1988 2; or

(f)a vehicle used or intended to be used for picking up or setting down goods or merchandising in a pedestrian mall which is being driven during a period when such vehicles are permitted to enter the pedestrian mall as designated by road signs erected at the entrance thereto; or

(g)a vehicle in respect of which the CEO has issued approval in writing, authorising the use of the vehicle in the pedestrian mall.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

[Regulation 292 amended: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4928; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

292A.Directions when road under repair etc.

Where —

(a)a portion of road is subject to work being done on, over or under it; or

(b)a survey is being conducted at any point on a road,

by or on behalf of an authorised body, a driver that is approaching or passing the place at which the work is being done or the survey is being conducted must comply with a direction given by a person who is apparently a servant, agent or delegate of the authorised body.

Points: 2Modified penalty: 3 PU

[Regulation 292A inserted: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6758; amended: SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

Division 3Stop lines and give way lines

293.Stop signs and stop lines

A reference to a “stop line” in a provision set out in the Table to this regulation, is to be taken to refer to a “stop line that is associated with a stop sign”.

Table

*Part 7 Division 1 – heading

*regulation 50: subregulations (2), (3) and (4)

*regulation 51: subregulations (2) and (3)

*regulation 52(1)

*Part 7 Division 2 – heading

*regulation 55: subregulations (1), (2), (3) and (5)

*regulation 56(1)

*regulation 57(1)

*regulation 58

*regulation 65.

294.Give way signs and give way lines

A reference to a “give way line” in a provision set out in the Table to this regulation, is to be taken to refer to a “give way line that is associated with a give way sign”.

Table

*Part 7 Division 1 – heading

*regulation 50(3)

*regulation 52: subregulations (2) and (3)

*regulation 54(2)

*Part 7 Division 2 – heading

*regulation 55: subregulations (1), (2), (3) and (5)

*regulation 56(1)

*regulation 57(1)

*regulation 58

*regulation 65.

[Regulation 294 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4608.]

Part 20 General

295.Authorisation to be in writing

A reference in these regulations to something that is authorised, means authorised by the person described as possessing that power, and the authorisation is to be in writing.

296.Delineation of parking areas etc.

A reference in these regulations to a portion of carriageway —

(a)between 2 traffic signs; or

(b)between a sign and a dead end; or

(c)to which a particular sign applies,

is a reference to the space extending towards its centre, marked on the adjacent carriageway; or, where a space is not so marked, if the sign is, or the signs are —

(d)erected at or near the boundary of a carriageway and not inscribed with the words, “angle parking”, the reference is limited to the area of the carriageway that is within 3 m of its boundary; and

(e)erected at or near the boundary of a carriageway and inscribed with the words “angle parking”, the reference is limited to the area of the carriageway within 6 m of its boundary.

[Regulation 296 amended: Gazette 8 Feb 2008 p. 320.]

297.Power to erect traffic‑control signals and road signs

(1)The Commissioner of Main Roads may erect, establish or display, and may alter or take down any road sign, road marking or traffic‑control signal.

(2)The Commissioner of Main Roads may allow an authorised body to erect, establish, display, alter or take down any particular road sign, road marking or traffic‑control signal, or road signs, road markings or traffic‑control signals of a class or type of classes or types, and in the circumstances (if any), specified in the instrument of authorisation.

(3)Where an authorised body is causing work to be undertaken or responsible for a survey, that authorised body may erect, establish, display, alter or take down any particular road sign or traffic‑control signal, or road signs or traffic‑control signals of a class or type of classes or types approved by the Commissioner of Main Roads so as to only apply to one lane, or one direction of, the carriageway to which the work or the survey relates.

(4)A person must not, without the consent of the Commissioner of Main Roads, remove, take down, damage, deface or interfere with any road sign, road marking or traffic‑control signal.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(4a)A person must not erect, establish, place, maintain or display —

(a)a traffic sign; or

(b)a traffic‑control signal; or

(c)a road marking,

on a road, unless that person —

(d)is authorised to do so by the Commissioner of Main Roads; or

(e)has the consent of the Commissioner of Main Roads to do so under this regulation; or

(f)is otherwise entitled to do so under a written law of the State.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(5)A person must not erect, establish, place, maintain or display, on a road, anything that —

(a)is a false representation of, or a colourable imitation of, a traffic sign or traffic‑control signal; or

(b)interferes with the effectiveness of, or of any part of, a traffic sign or traffic‑control signal; or

(c)prevents an approaching driver from clearly distinguishing the whole, or part, of a traffic sign or traffic‑control signal; or

(d)distracts a driver’s attention from a traffic sign or traffic‑control signal; or

(e)not being a traffic sign, displays a word or direction ordinarily associated with a traffic sign.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(6)Despite these regulations, a traffic sign or traffic‑control signal that was erected prior to the coming into operation of these regulations, is a valid and effective traffic sign or traffic‑control signal for the purposes of these regulations.

(7)The provisions of this regulation do not apply to the erection of road signs by any duly incorporated association or union of motorists approved by the Minister.

(8)Unless otherwise stated by the Commissioner of Main Roads, an authorised body may delegate the responsibility for the erection, establishment, display, alteration or the taking down of road signs in the circumstances set out in subregulation (2) or (3).

(9)Despite this regulation, where, for the purpose of temporarily controlling traffic it is expedient to do so, a police officer may erect or cause to be erected, road signs regulating the parking or stopping of vehicles and any sign so erected is a valid and effective traffic sign for the purposes of these regulations.

[Regulation 297 amended: Gazette 23 Sep 2003 p. 4172‑3; 6 Apr 2004 p. 1135‑6; 23 Dec 2014 p. 4926; SL 2020/253 r. 27.]

298.Unauthorised use of various traffic‑related items

(1)A person must not display, or cause to be displayed, a “give way to buses” sign on a bus that is not a public bus.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Give way to buses sign

(bus, arrow and edging in green, bus indicator in yellow,
words and car in red)

 

(2)A person must not display, or cause to be displayed, a “do not overtake turning vehicle” sign on the rearmost part of a vehicle (or of a combination, if that is the case) unless that vehicle (or combination) is 7.5 m or longer.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

Do not overtake turning vehicle sign

(background in yellow)

 

Do not overtake turning vehicle sign

(top right portion in red, remainder of background in yellow)

[Regulation 298 amended: Gazette 1 Dec 2000 p. 6757; SL 2020/253 r. 28.]

299.Limits on operation of signs

A traffic sign set out in Schedule 2 or Schedule 3 is limited in its operation and effect in respect of days, periods of the day, classes of persons, classes of vehicles or circumstances, to the extent, if any, shown on the sign.

300.All traffic‑control signals and traffic signs to be operative

(1)Where a traffic sign or traffic‑control signal indicates a requirement that is inconsistent with a provision of these regulations (other than a penalty provision), the traffic sign or traffic‑control signal prevails to the extent of the inconsistency.

(2)Where a traffic sign or traffic‑control signal of a kind referred to in these regulations is in existence on a road, it takes effect and operates as a traffic sign or traffic‑control signal duly established for the purposes of these regulations.

(3)A traffic sign or traffic‑control signal marked, erected, established or displayed on or near a road is, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, presumed to be a traffic sign or traffic‑control signal marked, erected, established or displayed under the authority of these regulations.

301.Inscriptions on signs to have effect according to their tenor

(1)An inscription on a road sign operates and has effect according to its tenor and a person who contravenes the directions of the inscription on a traffic sign commits an offence.

Modified penalty: 1 PU

(2)Schedule 1 provides the meaning of certain abbreviations and symbols used on road signs.

302.Variations in traffic signs etc.

(1)A traffic sign is to —

(a)be a reasonable likeness of any representation of that sign in these regulations or the Schedules to these regulations; or

(b)comply substantially with a description of that kind of traffic sign in these regulations.

(2)A road marking is to comply substantially with a description of that kind of road marking in these regulations.

(3)A traffic‑control signal is to comply substantially with a description of that kind of traffic‑control signal in these regulations.

(4)A traffic sign is taken to comply substantially with a representation of a traffic sign in these regulations even though —

(a)the dimensions of the sign, or of anything on the sign, are different; or

(b)the sign has additional information on or with it; or

(c)the number on the sign is different; or

(d)the sign has a different number of panels; or

(e)the sign is combined on a single panel with one or more other traffic signs; or

(f)for a parking control sign — words, figures, symbols, or anything else, on the sign are differently arranged; or

(g)for a “bus lane” sign, “emergency stopping bay” sign, “emergency stopping lane only” sign, “one‑way” sign or parking control sign — the sign has an arrow pointing in a different direction; or

(h)for a “shared path” sign or an “end shared path” sign — the pedestrian and bicycle symbols are reversed; or

(i)for a “separated footpath” sign or an “end separated footpath” sign — the pedestrian and bicycle symbols are reversed; or

(j)for a “road access” sign — information on or with the sign indicates (whether by different wording or in another way) that it applies to different or additional vehicles or persons; or

(k)there is a variation in shade or brightness between a colour on the sign and the equivalent colour (or description of a colour) in the diagram.

(5)A symbol on or in a traffic‑control signal or traffic sign has effect even if the dimensions of the symbol, or of anything on the symbol, are different.

[Regulation 302 amended: SL 2020/184 r. 25.]

303A.Audible lines

(1)An audible line is a line on a road that is made up of a series of closely spaced, raised pieces of material designed to create a continuous noise or vibration if driven on by a motor vehicle.

(2)To avoid doubt, an audible line is not a broken line by reason only of the gaps between the raised material in the series.

[Regulation 303A inserted: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4609.]

303.Operation of signs on holidays

Where a traffic sign indicates that an instruction applies on any particular day or days of the week, then that instruction does not apply on a day appointed to be observed as a public holiday in the district in which the sign is erected, unless the sign specifically indicates that it applies on public holidays.

304.Symbols, lights and traffic related items etc.

(1)Schedule 4 provides a description of certain symbols, lights and traffic related items referred to in these regulations.

(2)A symbol, light or traffic related item is to comply substantially with a description of that kind of symbol, light or traffic related item in these regulations.

305.Representations of traffic signs, traffic‑control signals, symbols etc. in these regulations

A diagrammatic representation of a traffic sign, traffic‑control signal, symbol, etc., in these regulations is accompanied by a description of the colour of various aspects of the diagrammatic representation, to ensure that either a colour version or a black‑and‑white version of these regulations conveys the appropriate information relating to that representation.

306.References to pedestrians crossing carriageway

In these regulations, a reference to a pedestrian crossing a carriageway includes a reference to a person who is crossing only part of a carriageway.

Example

A person walking to a median strip or to the middle of a carriageway to display a hand‑held stop sign is to be taken to be crossing the carriageway for the purposes of these regulations.

[Regulation 306 inserted: Gazette 19 Nov 2010 p. 5757.]

 

 

Schedule 1  Abbreviations and symbols

[r. 301(2)]

Abbreviation/Symbol

Meaning

MON

Monday

TUE

Tuesday

WED

Wednesday

THU

Thursday

FRI

Friday

SAT

Saturday

SUN

Sunday

JAN

January

FEB

February

MAR

March

APR

April

JUN

June

JUL

July

AUG

August

SEP

September

OCT

October

NOV

November

DEC

December

AM

the time after midnight and ending at noon

PM

the time after noon and ending at midnight

HOLS

holidays

MAX

maximum

MINS

minutes

PUB

public

VEH

vehicle

t

tonnes

m

metres

km

kilometres

km/h

kilometres per hour

˚

degree

Schedule 2Standard or commonly used traffic signs

[r. 299]

Area speed limit sign

(circle in red)

(regs 3, 11)

Area speed limit sign

(circle in red)

(regs 3, 11)

 

Arrester bed sign

 

(reg 91A)

 

Bicycle lane sign

 

(regs 3, 132, 218)

 

Bicycle parking sign

(letter, symbol, word and arrow in green)

(reg 169)

Bicycle path sign

 

(regs 3, 204, 218)

 

Bridge load limit (gross mass) sign

(reg 85)

Bridge load limit
(mass per axle group) sign

(reg 85)

 

Bus lane sign

(regs 3, 133)

Busway sign

(regs 3, 133A)

Busway cropped

 

Bus zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

(regs 3, 154)

Buses must enter sign

(reg 89)

 

Children crossing ‑ stop sign

(octagonal background in red)

(square background in lime/yellow)

(regs 3, 61, 62)

Clearance sign

 

(reg 84)

 

Clearway sign

(background to letter in red)

(reg 148)

De‑restriction sign

 

(regs 3, 11)

 

Emergency stopping lane only sign

(reg 3, 76, 150)

End area speed limit sign

(reg 3, 11)

 

End bicycle lane sign

(regs 3, 132)

End bicycle path sign

(regs 3, 204)

 

End bus lane sign

(regs 3, 133)

End busway sign

(regs 3, 133A)

Busway and end cropped

 

End clearway sign

(background to letter in red)

(reg 148)

End freeway sign

(background in green)

(regs 3, 78, 149)

 

End keep left unless overtaking sign

(reg 113)

End keep left unless overtaking sign

(reg 113)

 

End no bicycles sign

(circle and slash in red)

(regs 204, 218)

End no overtaking or passing sign

(reg 74)

 

End road access sign

 

(regs 78, 195)

End school zone sign

(circle in red)

(regs 3, 11)

60

 

End separated footpath sign

(regs 3, 204)

End shared path sign

(regs 3, 208)

 

End shared zone sign

(regs 3, 11)

End speed limit sign

(reg 11)

 

End transit lane sign
(End transit lane (T2) sign)

(background to “T2” in red)

(regs 3, 134)

End transit lane sign
(End transit lane (T3) sign)

(background to “T3” in red)

(regs 3, 134)

 

End truck lane sign

(regs 3, 135)

End trucks and buses low gear sign

(reg 90)

 

End trucks use left lane sign

(reg 137)

Freeway sign

(background in green)

(regs 3, 149)

 

Freeway sign

(background in green)

(regs 3, 149)

Give way sign

(triangle in red)

(regs 52, 53, 54, 103)

 

Gross load limit sign

(reg 85)

Hand‑held stop sign

(background in red)

(regs 3, 83)

 

Hand‑held stop sign

(background in orange)

(regs 3, 83)

Keep left sign

(regs 80, 81)

 

Keep left unless overtaking sign

(reg 113)

Keep right sign

(regs 81, 117)

 

Left lane must turn left sign

(regs 69, 113)

Left turn on red after stopping sign

(reg 43)

 

Left turn only sign

(reg 69)

Level crossing sign

(reg 3)

 

Level crossing sign

(background to cross in red)

(reg 3)

Loading zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

(regs 3, 151)

 

Low clearance sign

 

(reg 84)

Mail zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

(regs 3, 155)

 

Median turning lane sign

 

(reg 67)

Motor cycle parking sign

(letter, words and arrow in green)

(reg 170)

 

No bicycles sign

(circle and slash in red)

(regs 3, 204, 218)

No buses sign

(circle and slash in red

(reg 88)

 

No entry sign

(circular background in red)

(reg 82)

No hook turn by bicycles sign

 

(regs 28, 29)

 

No left turn sign (Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

(reg 72)

No left turn sign
(Variable illuminated message sign)

(illuminated circle and slash in red)

(reg 72)

 

No overtaking on bridge sign

 

(reg 75)

No overtaking or passing sign

 

(reg 74)

 

No parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(circle, slash and arrow in red)

(regs 3, 141)

No parking sign
(for an area)

(circle and slash in red)

(regs 3, 141)

 

No pedestrians sign

(circle and slash in red)

(reg 194)

 

No right turn sign
(Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

(reg 72)

 

No right turn sign
(Variable illuminated message sign)

(illuminated circle and slash in red)

(reg 72)

No right turn sign

(letters illuminated in white)

(reg 72)

 

No stopping sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(circle, slash and arrow in red)

(regs 3, 138)

No stopping sign
(for an area)

(circle and slash in red)

(regs 3, 138)

 

No trucks sign

(circle and slash in red)

(reg 86)

No turns sign

 

(reg 71)

 

No U turn sign (Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

(regs 30, 31)

No U turn sign (Variable illuminated message sign)

(illuminated circle and slash in red)

(regs 30, 31)

 

No wheeled recreational devices, scooters or toys sign

(circle and slash in red)

(reg 206)

206A

No wheeled recreational devices, scooters or toys sign

(circles and slashes in red)

(reg 206)

206B

 

One‑way sign

(reg 80)

One way sign

(reg 80)

 

Park in bays only sign

 

(reg 179)

Pedestrian crossing sign

(background in yellow)

(regs 3, 63)

 

Pedestrians may cross diagonally sign

(pedestrian symbol in green)

(regs 196, 199)

People with disabilities parking sign

(background to symbol in blue)

(reg 171)

 

Permissive parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(letter and arrow in green)

(reg 172)

Permissive parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(letter, word and arrow in green)

(reg 172)

 

Permissive parking sign
(for an area)

(letter in green)

(reg 172)

Permissive parking sign displaying a people with disabilities symbol
(for a length of carriageway)

(letter and arrow in green, word and background to symbol in blue)

(reg 171)

 

Permissive parking sign displaying a people with disabilities symbol
(for an area)

(letter in green, background to symbol in blue)

(reg 171)

Right lane must turn right sign

 

(reg 70)

 

Right turn only sign

 

(reg 70)

Road access sign

 

(regs 78, 195)

 

Roundabout sign

(triangle in red)

(reg 91)

Safety ramp sign

 

(reg 91A)

 

School zone sign

(circle in red)

(regs 3, 11)

Separated footpath sign

(regs 3, 204, 218)

 

Shared path sign

(regs 3, 208, 218)

Shared zone sign

(circle in red)

(regs 3, 11)

 

Slow vehicle turnout lane sign

 

(reg 113)

 

Speed limit sign
(Standard sign)

(circle in red)

(regs 3, 11)

 

Stop here on red arrow sign

(words and border in red)

(reg 40)

Stop here on red signal sign

(words and border in red)

(reg 40)

 

Stop sign

(background in red)

(regs 3, 50, 101)

Taxi zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

(regs 3, 154)

 

Traffic light–stop sign

(background in red)

(regs 3, 46)

Transit lane sign
(Transit lane (T2) sign)

(background to “T2” in red)

(regs 3, 134)

 

Transit lane sign
(Transit lane (T3) sign)

(background to “T3” in red)

(regs 3, 134)

Truck lane sign

(regs 3, 135)

 

Trucks and buses low gear sign

(reg 90)

Trucks must enter sign

(reg 87)

 

Trucks use left lane sign

(reg 137)

Truck zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

(regs 3, 152)

 

Two‑way sign

 

(regs 80, 118)

U turn permitted sign

 

(regs 31, 72)

 

Works zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

(regs 3, 153)

[Schedule 2 amended: Gazette 13 Jul 2001 p. 3474‑5; 11 Jan 2002 p. 52; 29 Dec 2006 p. 5924; 8 Feb 2008 p. 320; 13 Nov 2009 p. 4609‑12; SL 2020/184 r. 26.]

Schedule 3Other permitted traffic signs

[r. 299]

NoteIn addition to the traffic signs in the Schedules to these regulations, the following are alternative versions of the signs that may be used to regulate traffic in this jurisdiction. These signs are not included in the Australian Standard AS1742 (Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices), but they may be still in use on roads in Western Australia.

 

Arrester bed sign

(reg 91A)

Arrester bed sign

(reg 91A)

 

Bicycle lane sign

 

(regs 3, 132, 218)

Bridge load limit
(mass per axle group) sign

(reg 85)

 

Bridge load limit
(mass per axle group) sign

(reg 85)

Bus lane sign

(regs 3, 133)

 

Bus lane sign

(regs 3, 133)

Bus lane sign

(regs 3, 133)

 

Bus lane sign

(regs 3, 133)

Bus lane sign

(regs 3, 133)

 

Bus lane sign

(regs 3, 133)

Buses must enter sign

(reg 89)

 

Bus zone sign

(arrow and words in red)

(regs 3, 154)

Bus zone sign

(arrow and words in red)

(regs 3, 154)

 

Emergency stopping bay sign

(background to “emergency” in red)

(regs 3, 76A, 150)

Emergency Stopping Bay Only

Emergency stopping bay sign

(background to phone in blue)

(regs 3, 76A, 150)

 

End area speed limit sign

(regs 3, 11)

End bus lane sign

(regs 3, 133)

End freeway sign

(background in green)

(regs 3, 78, 149)

End keep left unless overtaking sign

(reg 113)

 

End school zone sign

(circle in red)

(regs 3, 11)

End school zone sign

 

(regs 3, 11)

 

 

End school zone sign

 

(regs 3, 11)

end of school zone

End school zone sign

(circle in red)

(regs 3, 11)

 

End trucks and buses low gear sign

(reg 90)

Freeway sign

(background in green)

(regs 3, 149)

 

Hand‑held stop sign

(background in red)

(regs 3, 83)

Keep right sign

(regs 81, 117)

 

Left lane must turn left sign

(reg 69)

Left turn only sign

(reg 69)

SCHEDUL1

 

Left turn only sign

(reg 69)

Loading zone sign

(arrow and background to words in red)

(regs 3, 151)

 

No bicycles sign

(reg 204, 218)

No entry sign

(circle and slash in red

(reg 82)

 

No entry sign

(circular background in red)

(reg 82)

No entry sign

 

(reg 82)

 

No entry sign

(reg 82)

No left turn sign
(Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

(reg 72)

 

No left turn sign
(Variable illuminated message sign)

(illuminated circle and slash in red)

(reg 72)

No overtaking on bridge sign

 

(reg 75)

 

No parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(edging, words and arrow in red)

(regs 3, 141)

No parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(edging, words and arrow in red)

(regs 3, 141)

 

No parking sign
(for an area)

(circle and slash in red)

(regs 3, 141)

No parking sign
(for an area)

(edging, words and arrow in red)

(regs 3, 141)

 

No right turn sign
(Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

(reg 72)

No right turn sign
(Standard sign)

(illuminated circle and slash in red)

(reg 72)

 

No right turn sign

(letters illuminated in white)

(reg 72)

No stopping sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(background in red)

(regs 3, 140)

 

No stopping sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(edge, words and arrow in red)

(regs 3, 140)

No stopping sign
(for an area)

(circle and slash in red)

(regs 3, 140)

 

No U turn sign
(Standard sign)

(circle and slash in red)

(regs 30, 31)

No U turn sign
(Variable illuminated message sign)

(illuminated circle and slash in red)

(regs 30, 31)

 

One vehicle per green each lane sign

(reg 39A)

One‑way sign

(reg 80)

 

 

One‑way sign

(reg 80)

Pedestrians may cross diagonally sign

 

(regs 196, 199)

 

Permissive parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(word and arrow in green)

(reg 172)

Permissive parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(edge, word and arrow in green)

(reg 172)

 

Permissive parking sign
(for a length of carriageway)

(edge, word and arrow in green)

(reg 172)

Permissive parking sign
(for an area)

(letter in green)

(reg 172)

 

Permissive parking sign
(for an area)

(letter in green)

(reg 172)

Right lane must turn right sign

(reg 70)

 

Right turn only sign

(reg 70)

Right turn only sign

(reg 70)

 

Road access sign

(reg 78)

Road access sign

(regs 78, 195)

Schedule 3 - road access sign

 

Road access sign

(regs 78, 195)

Schedule 3 - road access sign

School zone sign

(shading in orange, circle illuminated in red)

(regs 3, 11)

School Zone Example with Variable Speed

 

School zone sign

(shading in orange, circle in red)

(regs 3, 11)

Shared path sign

(background circle in blue)

(regs 208, 218)

blue rt code colour

 

 

Speed limit sign
(Variable illuminated sign)

(circle illuminated in red)

(regs 3, 11)

Speed limit sign
(Variable illuminated sign)

(circle illuminated in red)

(regs 3, 11)

Variable Speed Limit White Background

 

Stop here on red signal sign

 

(reg 40)

Taxi zone sign

(arrow, edge and words in red)

(regs 3, 154)

 

Taxi zone sign

 

(regs 3, 154)

Taxi zone sign

(arrow, edge and words in red)

(regs 3, 154)

 

Trucks and buses low gear sign

 

(reg 90)

Trucks and buses low gear sign

(yellow lights)

(reg 90)

 

Trucks must enter sign

(reg 87)

Trucks use left lane sign

 

(reg 137)

 

Truck zone sign

(arrow and words in red)

(regs 3, 152)

Two‑way sign

 

(regs 80, 118)

 

When blank sign
(When all signs blank)

(circle in red)

(reg 11A)

When blank sign
(When sign blank)

(circle in red)

(reg 11A)

 

Works zone sign

(arrow and words in red)

(regs 3, 153)

[Schedule 3 amended: Gazette 13 Nov 2009 p. 4612‑15; SL 2020/184 r. 27.]

Schedule 4Symbols, lights and traffic‑related items

[r. 304]

Do not overtake turning vehicle sign

(background in yellow)

(regs 21, 26, 123, 127)

 

Do not overtake turning vehicle sign

(top right portion in red, remainder of background in yellow)

(regs 21, 26, 123, 127)

 

Fire hydrant indicator (example)

(regs 3, 163)

Fire hydrant indicator (example)

(regs 3, 163)

 

Fire plug indicator (example)

(regs 3, 163)

Give way to buses sign

(bus, arrow and edging in green, bus indicator in yellow, words and car in red)

(regs 59, 298)

 

Green bicycle crossing light

(bicycle symbol in green)

(regs 3, 225)

Green pedestrian light

(pedestrian symbol in green)

(regs 3, 197)

 

Illuminated diagonal arrow signal

(reg 131)

Illuminated diagonal arrow signal

(reg 131)

 

Illuminated red diagonal cross

(cross illuminated in red)

(reg 3, 131)

People with disabilities symbol

(background to symbol in blue)

(reg 171)

 

People with disabilities symbol

(symbol in blue)

(reg 171)

Red bicycle crossing light

(bicycle symbol in red)

(reg 3, 225)

 

Red pedestrian light

(pedestrian symbol in red)

(reg 3, 197)

White B light

 

(regs 3, 251)

 

Yellow bicycle crossing light

(bicycle symbol in yellow)

(regs 3, 226)

[Schedule 4 amended: SL 2020/184 r. 28.]

Schedule 5  O’Connor Industrial Area

[r. 138A]

[Heading inserted: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4926.]

The O’Connor Industrial Area is the area bordered by —

•South Street between the intersections of South Street and Ladner Way and South Street and Hines Road;

•Hines Road between the intersections of Hines Road and South Street and Hines Road and Clarke Street;

•Clarke Street between the intersections of Clarke Street and Hines Road and Clarke Street and Carrington Street;

•Carrington Street between the intersections of Carrington Street and Clarke Street and Carrington Street and Sainsbury Road;

•Sainsbury Road between the intersection of Sainsbury Road and Carrington Street and the southern point of the eastern boundary of the Fremantle cemetery;

•the eastern boundary of the Fremantle cemetery between Sainsbury Road and Leach Highway;

•Leach Highway from the northern point of the eastern boundary of the Fremantle cemetery to the intersection of Leach Highway and Stock Road;

•Stock Road between the intersections of Stock Road and Leach Highway and Stock Road and Garling Street;

•Garling Street between the intersections of Garling Street and Stock Road and Garling Street and Bowen Street;

•Bowen Street between the intersections of Bowen Street and Garling Street and Bowen Street and Winterburn Way;

•Winterburn Way until it reaches Ladner Street;

•Ladner Street between the intersections of Ladner Street and Winterburn Way and Ladner Street and South Street.

For information purposes the area described above is shown on the following map.

D3 Map Test1

[Schedule 5 inserted: Gazette 23 Dec 2014 p. 4926‑7.]

dline

 

Notes

This is a compilation of the Road Traffic Code 2000 and includes amendments made by other written laws. For provisions that have come into operation, and for information about any reprints, see the compilation table. For provisions that have not yet come into operation see the uncommenced provisions table.

Compilation table

Citation

Published

Commencement

Road Traffic Code 2000

4 Aug 2000 p. 4213‑538

1 Dec 2000 (see r. 2)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 4) 2000 3

1 Dec 2000 p. 6751‑7

1 Dec 2000 (see r. 2 and Gazette 4 Aug 2000 p. 4229)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 5) 2000

1 Dec 2000 p. 6758

1 Jun 2001 (see r. 2)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 6) 2000

1 Dec 2000 p. 6797

1 Dec 2000 (see r. 2)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2001

25 Jan 2001 p. 593

25 Jan 2001

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2001

13 Jul 2001
p. 3472‑5

5 Aug 2001 (see r. 2)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2001

16 Nov 2001 p. 5989‑90

1 Dec 2001 (see r. 2)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 5) 2001

8 Jan 2002
p. 38

5 Feb 2002 (see r. 2)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 4) 2001

11 Jan 2002 p. 50‑2

11 Jan 2002

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2002

8 Mar 2002 p. 946‑8

8 Mar 2002

Road Traffic (Vehicle Standards) (Consequential Provisions) Regulations 2002 Pt. 7

1 Nov 2002 p. 5388‑400

1 Nov 2002 (see r. 2)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2002

11 Dec 2002 p. 5789‑90

11 Dec 2002

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2003

16 Apr 2003 p. 1240

16 Apr 2003

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 4) 2003

11 Jun 2003 p. 2103

11 Jun 2003

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2003 1

23 Sep 2003 p. 4166‑73

23 Sep 2003

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 5) 2003

12 Dec 2003 p. 5047‑8

12 Dec 2003

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2004

6 Apr 2004 p. 1134‑6

6 Apr 2004

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2004

30 Jul 2004 p. 3106‑7

30 Jul 2004

Reprint 1: The Road Traffic Code 2000 as at 27 Aug 2004 (includes amendments listed above)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2004

10 Dec 2004 p. 5917

10 Dec 2004

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2005

23 Dec 2005 p. 6291

1 Jan 2006 (see r. 2 and Gazette 23 Dec 2005 p. 6244‑5)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 4) 2006

22 Dec 2006 p. 5817‑22

1 Jan 2007 (see r. 2)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2006

29 Dec 2006 p. 5921‑5

29 Dec 2006

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2007

9 Mar 2007 p. 848‑9

9 Mar 2007

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2007

5 Apr 2007 p. 1553‑8

5 Apr 2007

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2007

2 Oct 2007 p. 4975‑6

2 Oct 2007 4 (see r. 2)

Reprint 2: The Road Traffic Code 2000 as at 12 Oct 2007 (includes amendments listed above)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2008

8 Feb 2008 p. 315-20

r. 1 and 2: 8 Feb 2008 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 9 Feb 2008 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Amendment (Holiday Periods) Regulations 2008 r. 4

8 Feb 2008 p. 321-2

9 Feb 2008 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 4) 2008

29 Feb 2008 p. 694-8

r. 1 and 2: 29 Feb 2008 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 1 Mar 2008 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Consequential Amendment Regulations 2008 Pt. 6

10 Jun 2008 p. 2449-67

30 Jun 2008 (see r. 2(b) and Gazette 10 Jun 2008 p. 2471)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2009

18 Sep 2009 p. 3626-7

r. 1 and 2: 18 Sep 2009 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 19 Sep 2009 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 5) 2009

9 Oct 2009 p. 3996

r. 1 and 2: 9 Oct 2009 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 10 Oct 2009 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 4) 2009

13 Nov 2009 p. 4541

r. 1 and 2: 13 Nov 2009 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 14 Nov 2009 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2009

13 Nov 2009 p. 4561‑615

r. 1 and 2: 13 Nov 2009 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 14 Nov 2009 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2010

4 Jun 2010 p. 2395-415

r. 1 and 2: 4 Jun 2010 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 1 Oct 2010 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2010

19 Nov 2010 p. 5749‑57

r. 1 and 2: 19 Nov 2010 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1, 2, 22 and 23: 20 Nov 2010 (see r. 2(c));
r. 22 and 23: 1 Mar 2011 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2010

26 Nov 2010 p. 5958-9

r. 1 and 2: 26 Nov 2010 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 27 Nov 2010 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic (Towed Agricultural Implements) Amendment Regulations 2010 Pt. 3

7 Dec 2010 p. 6096‑100

8 Dec 2010 (see r. 2(b))

Reprint 3: The Road Traffic Code 2000 as at 7 Jan 2011 (includes amendments listed above except those in the Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2010 r. 22 and 23)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2011

18 Mar 2011 p. 925‑6

r. 1 and 2: 18 Mar 2011 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 19 Mar 2011 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2011

30 Aug 2011 p. 3517‑18

r. 1 and 2: 30 Aug 2011 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 31 Aug 2011 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2013

12 Apr 2013 p. 1533‑9

r. 1 and 2: 12 Apr 2013 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 13 Apr 2013 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2013

31 Dec 2013 p. 6562‑70

r. 1 and 2: 31 Dec 2013 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 1 Apr 2014 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2014

4 Apr 2014 p. 885-6

r. 1 and 2: 4 Apr 2014 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 5 Apr 2014 (see r. 2(b))

Reprint 4: The Road Traffic Code 2000 as at 25 Jul 2014 (includes amendments listed above)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2014

9 Sep 2014 p. 3243‑7

r. 1 and 2: 9 Sep 2014 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 26 Sep 2014 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 5) 2014

31 Oct 2014 p. 4181

r. 1 and 2: 31 Oct 2014 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 1 Nov 2014 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic (Repeals and Amendment) Regulations 2014 Pt. 4

23 Dec 2014 p. 4913‑38

27 Apr 2015 (see r. 2(b) and Gazette 17 Apr 2015 p. 1371)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2015

13 Feb 2015 p. 651‑2

r. 1 and 2: 13 Feb 2015 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 14 Feb 2015 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2015

16 Oct 2015 p. 4152

r. 1 and 2: 16 Oct 2015 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 17 Oct 2015 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 4) 2015

22 Dec 2015 p. 5131

r. 1 and 2: 22 Dec 2015 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 23 Dec 2015 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2016

26 Apr 2016 p. 1277‑8

r. 1 and 2: 26 Apr 2016 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 27 Apr 2016 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2016

15 Nov 2016 p. 5061‑2

r. 1 and 2: 15 Nov 2016 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 28 Nov 2016 (see r. 2(b))

Reprint 5: The Road Traffic Code 2000 as at 9 Dec 2016 (includes amendments listed above)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2017

25 Jul 2017 p. 4078‑80

r. 1 and 2: 25 Jul 2017 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 5 Sep 2017 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 4) 2017

22 Aug 2017 p. 4503‑4

r. 1 and 2: 22 Aug 2017 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 23 Aug 2017 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2017

17 Oct 2017 p. 5338‑41

r. 1 and 2: 17 Oct 2017 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2:
13 Dec 2017 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 5) 2017

31 Oct 2017 p. 5464‑5

r. 1 and 2: 31 Oct 2017 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 1 Nov 2017 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 6) 2017

31 Oct 2017 p. 5462‑4

r. 1 and 2: 31 Oct 2017 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 30 Nov 2017 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 8) 2017

5 Jan 2018 p. 9‑10

r. 1 and 2: 5 Jan 2018 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 2 Mar 2018 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2018

15 May 2018 p. 1531‑6

r. 1 and 2: 15 May 2018 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 27 Jun 2018 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2019

28 Jun 2019 p. 2488‑9

r. 1 and 2: 28 Jun 2019 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 2 Jul 2019 (see r. 2(b) and Gazette 28 Jun 2019 p. 2473)

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2019

31 Dec 2019 p. 4686

r. 1 and 2: 31 Dec 2019 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 1 Jan 2020 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2020

SL 2020/87 26 Jun 2020

r. 1 and 2: 26 Jun 2020 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 1 Sep 2020 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 2) 2020

SL 2020/184 29 Sep 2020

r. 1 and 2: 29 Sep 2020 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 20 Nov 2020 (see r. 2(b))

Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 3) 2020

SL 2020/253 24 Dec 2020 (as amended by SL 2021/30 r. 4 5)

r. 1 and 2: 24 Dec 2020 (see r. 2(a));
Regulations other than r. 1 and 2: 29 Mar 2021 (see r. 2(b))

Other notes

1The Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2003 r. 14(2) reads as follows:

 

(2)On the commencement of these regulations, a person who is the subject of an authorised person declaration by the Director General is to continue as an authorised person as if the declaration had been made by the Commissioner of Police.

 

2Formerly referred to the Liquor Licensing Act 1988 the short title of which was changed to the Liquor Control Act 1988 by the Liquor and Gaming Legislation Amendment Act 2006 s. 4. The reference was changed under the Reprints Act 1984 s. 7(3)(gb).

3The Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations (No. 4) 2000 r. 5 is not included because of an error in the reference to the provision to be amended.

4The commencement date of 1 Oct 2007 that was specified in r. 2(b) was before the date of gazettal.

5The Road Traffic Code Amendment Regulations 2021 r. 4 (SL 2021/30) commenced on 27 Mar 2021 (see r. 2(b)).

 

Defined terms

 

[This is a list of terms defined and the provisions where they are defined. The list is not part of the law.]

Defined termProvision(s)

2-wheeled motor cycle130A(1)

agricultural implement289(3)

agricultural machine289(3)

alcohol ignition interlock device3(1)

appliance181(4)

appropriate vehicle230B(2)

arrester bed91A(1)

articulated vehicle3(1)

AS/NZS:1754-1995230

audio call265(1)

authorised body3(1)

authorised person3(1)

average speed detection system18A(1)

B-double110(1)

bicycle3(1)

bicycle crossing lights3(1)

bicycle hook turn storage area3(1)

bicycle lane3(1)

bicycle path3(1)

bicycle path road marking3(1)

bicycle storage area3(1)

bicycle trailer223(3)

B light3(1)

B lights3(1)

body265(1)

booster seat230

Botanic Gardens and Parks Authority3(1)

built-up area3(1)

bus3(1)

bus embayment3(1)

bus lane3(1)

“bus lane” road marking3(1)

bus stop3(1)

busway3(1)

bus zone3(1)

carriageway3(1)

centre3(1)

children’s crossing3(1)

child restraint230

child safety harness230

combination3(1)

commercial operator230A

continuing road3(1)

continuous dividing line176(12)

corresponding illuminated speed sign11A(1)

dangerous goods184(4)

default speed limit3(1)

de-restriction sign3(1)

dipped3(1)

dipping device3(1)

disability parking permit3(1)

dividing line3(1)

dividing strip3(1)

edge line3(1)

electric personal transporter3(1)

electric personal transporter use area3(1)

emergency stopping bay3(1)

emergency stopping lane3(1)

emergency vehicle3(1)

emergency worker283(2)

“end of heavy vehicle speed zone” sign3(1)

“end trucks and buses low gear” sign90(3)

EPT3(4)

EPT use area3(4)

fire hydrant3(1)

footpath3(1)

freeway3(1)

freight container138A(1)

front fog light3(1)

g258(7)

give way line3(1)

halfway around91(2)

hazard warning light137A(1)

hazard warning lights188(2)

heavy vehicle3(1), 191(1), 192(1)

heavy vehicle speed zone3(1)

“heavy vehicle speed zone” sign3(1)

held265(1)

holiday period3(1)

hook turn3(1)

hours of darkness3(1)

incident response vehicle137A(1)

intersection3(1)

keep clear marking3(1)

laned carriageway3(1)

lane filtering130B(1) and (2)

leaves181(4)

left lane21(3), 59(2)

left line of traffic59(2)

left turn signal91(1)

level crossing3(1)

licenced pilot vehicle driver3(1)

loading zone3(1)

long vehicle110(1)

mail zone3(1)

marked foot crossing3(1)

marked lane113(1)

median strip3(1)

medical certificate230

medical practitioner230

mobile phone265(1)

moped79(2), 130(5)

motor break-down service vehicle288A(1)

motor cycle3(1), 130(5), 246A(1), 246B(1)

motorised scooter3(1)

motorised wheelchair3(1)

motor vehicle3(1)

nature strip3(1)

no bicycles road marking3(1)

no parking area3(1)

no stopping area3(1)

obstruction3(1)

O’Connor Industrial Area138A(1)

on-demand rank or hail vehicle authorisation3(1)

one-way carriageway3(1)

operator 230A

overhead controlled lane3(1)

oversize3(1)

painted island3(1)

park3(1)

parking area3(1)

parking area for people with disabilities171(2)

parking control sign3(1)

passenger transport vehicle3(1)

path3(1)

pedestrian3(1), 203(6)

pedestrian crossing3(1)

pedestrian light3(1)

pedestrian mall3(1)

performance standards258(7)

permitted distance136(5)

placard load184(4)

postal vehicle3(1)

primary brake90(3)

produced230

prohibited road138A(1)

protective helmet209A(1), 222(1), 223A(1), 223(3), 230A, 244(1)

public bus3(1), 59(2)

rear fog light3(1)

red X lane3(1)

relevant time230

required time141(2)

restricted area265(1A)

rider3(1)

right lane26(3), 113(1)

right turn signal91(1)

road marking3(1)

road sign3(1)

road train110(1)

roadworks285(4)

roundabout91(1)

safety area197(3), 198(3)

safety ramp91A(1)

school zone3(1)

school zone periods3(1)

scooter3(1)

seatbelt 230

seating position230

separated footpath3(1)

separated footpath road marking3(1)

service road3(1)

shared path3(1)

shared path road marking3(1)

shared zone3(1)

shared zone sign3(1)

slip lane3(1)

slow vehicle turn out lane113(1)

special purpose lane3(1)

special purpose vehicle3(1)

speed limit3(1)

speed limited area3(1)

speed limit sign3(1)

speed measuring and recording equipment18A(1)

speed zone3(1)

staff member230A

stop3(1)

stop line3(1)

stop sign3(1)

suitable child restraint230

suitable child safety harness230

supervised tour230A, 230L(1)

taxi3(1)

taxi zone3(1)

terminating road3(1)

T-intersection3(1)

to become dislodged from257(5)

tow truck3(1)

traffic-control signal3(1)

traffic island3(1)

traffic sign3(1)

trailer3(1)

train3(1)

transit lane3(1)

truck3(1)

truck lane3(1)

“trucks and buses low gear” sign90(3)

truck zone3(1)

turning lane3(1)

turning left34(1)

turning left from the continuing road into the terminating road56(7)

turning right34(2) and (3)

turning right from the continuing road into the terminating road56(7)

turn line3(1)

two-up driver230

two-way carriageway3(1)

unattended141(2), 163(2)

unrestrained235A(1)

use265(1)

U turn3(1)

variable illuminated speed limit sign3(1)

vehicle3(1), 110(1) and (3)

Vehicle Standards3(1)

weekend3(1)

wheeled recreational device3(1)

wheeled toy3(1)

“when blank” sign11A(1)

works zone3(1)